]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
*** empty log message ***
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 1999, 2000,01,02,03,04
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
134 #define XAW_ARROW_SCROLLBARS
135 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
136 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
137 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
138 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
139 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
140 #ifndef XtNpickTop
141 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
142 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
143 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
144 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
145
146 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
147
148 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
149 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
150 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
151 #endif
152
153 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
154 #include "widget.h"
155 #ifndef XtNinitialState
156 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
157 #endif
158 #endif
159
160 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
161
162 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
163 #ifdef USE_XIM
164 int use_xim = 1;
165 #else
166 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
167 #endif
168
169 \f
170
171 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
172
173 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
174
175 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
176 start. */
177
178 static int any_help_event_p;
179
180 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
181 static Lisp_Object last_window;
182
183 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
184
185 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
186
187 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
188 use. */
189
190 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
191
192 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
193 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
194 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
195 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
196
197 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
198
199 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
200 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
201 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
202 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
203
204 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
205
206 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
207
208 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
209
210 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
211 /* The application context for Xt use. */
212 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
213 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
214 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
215
216 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
217
218 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
219
220 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
221 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
222
223 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
224
225 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
226 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
227 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
228
229 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
230
231 /* Mouse movement.
232
233 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
234 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
235 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
236 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
237
238 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
239
240 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
241 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
242 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
243 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
244 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
245 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
246 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
247 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
248 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
249 is off. */
250
251 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
252
253 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
254 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
255
256 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
257
258 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
259 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
260 an ordinary motion.
261
262 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
263 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
264 event. */
265
266 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
267
268 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
269 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
270 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
271 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
272 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
273 it's somewhat accurate. */
274
275 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
276
277 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
278 events. */
279
280 #ifdef __STDC__
281 static int volatile input_signal_count;
282 #else
283 static int input_signal_count;
284 #endif
285
286 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
287
288 static int x_noop_count;
289
290 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
291
292 extern char **initial_argv;
293 extern int initial_argc;
294
295 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
296
297 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
298
299 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
300
301 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
302
303 extern int errno;
304
305 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
306
307 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
308
309 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
310
311 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
312 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
313 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
314
315 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
316 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
317
318 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
319 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
320
321 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
322 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
323 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
324 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
325 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
326 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
327 unsigned));
328 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
329 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
330 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
331 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
332 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
333 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
334 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
335 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
336 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
337 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
338 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
339 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
340 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
341 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
343 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
344 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
345 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
346 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
347 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
348 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
349 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
350 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
351 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
352 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
353 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
354 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
355 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
356 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
357 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
358 enum text_cursor_kinds));
359
360 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
361 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
362 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
363 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
364 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
365 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
366 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
367 enum scroll_bar_part *,
368 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
369 unsigned long *));
370 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
371 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
372 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
373 int *, struct input_event *));
374
375
376 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
377
378 static void
379 x_flush (f)
380 struct frame *f;
381 {
382 BLOCK_INPUT;
383 if (f == NULL)
384 {
385 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
386 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
387 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
388 }
389 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
390 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
391 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
392 }
393
394
395 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
396 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
397 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
398 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
399 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
400 performance. */
401
402 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
403
404 \f
405 /***********************************************************************
406 Debugging
407 ***********************************************************************/
408
409 #if 0
410
411 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
412 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
413
414 struct record
415 {
416 char *locus;
417 int type;
418 };
419
420 struct record event_record[100];
421
422 int event_record_index;
423
424 record_event (locus, type)
425 char *locus;
426 int type;
427 {
428 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
429 event_record_index = 0;
430
431 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
432 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
433 event_record_index++;
434 }
435
436 #endif /* 0 */
437
438
439 \f
440 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
441
442 struct x_display_info *
443 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
444 Display *dpy;
445 {
446 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
447
448 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
449 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
450 return dpyinfo;
451
452 return 0;
453 }
454
455
456 \f
457 /***********************************************************************
458 Starting and ending an update
459 ***********************************************************************/
460
461 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
462 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
463 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
464 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
465 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
466
467 static void
468 x_update_begin (f)
469 struct frame *f;
470 {
471 /* Nothing to do. */
472 }
473
474
475 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
476 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
477 position of W. */
478
479 static void
480 x_update_window_begin (w)
481 struct window *w;
482 {
483 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
484 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
485
486 updated_window = w;
487 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
488
489 BLOCK_INPUT;
490
491 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
492 {
493 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
494 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
495
496 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
497 highlighting. */
498 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
499 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
500
501 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
502 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
503 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
504 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
505 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
506 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
507
508 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
509 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
510 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
511 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
512 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
513 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
514 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
515 {
516 int i;
517
518 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
519 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
520 break;
521
522 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
523 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
524 }
525 #endif /* 0 */
526 }
527
528 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
529 }
530
531
532 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
533
534 static void
535 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
536 struct window *w;
537 int x, y0, y1;
538 {
539 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
540
541 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
542 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
543 }
544
545 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
546
547 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
548 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
549
550 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
551 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
552 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
553
554 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
555 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
556 here. */
557
558 static void
559 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
560 struct window *w;
561 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
562 {
563 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
564
565 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
566 {
567 BLOCK_INPUT;
568
569 if (cursor_on_p)
570 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
571 output_cursor.vpos,
572 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
573
574 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
575 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
576
577 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
578 }
579
580 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
581 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
582 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
583 {
584 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
585 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
586 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
587 }
588
589 updated_window = NULL;
590 }
591
592
593 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
594 update_end. */
595
596 static void
597 x_update_end (f)
598 struct frame *f;
599 {
600 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
601 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
602
603 #ifndef XFlush
604 BLOCK_INPUT;
605 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
606 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
607 #endif
608 }
609
610
611 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
612 complete update has been performed. The global variable
613 updated_window is not available here. */
614
615 static void
616 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
617 struct frame *f;
618 {
619 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
620 {
621 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
622
623 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
624 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
625 {
626 BLOCK_INPUT;
627 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
628 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
629 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
630 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
631 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
632 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
633 }
634 }
635 }
636
637
638 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
639 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
640 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
641 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
642 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
643 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
644
645 static void
646 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
647 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
648 {
649 struct window *w = updated_window;
650 struct frame *f;
651 int width, height;
652
653 xassert (w);
654
655 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
656 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
657
658 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
659 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
660 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
661 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
662 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
663 overhead is very small. */
664 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
665 && desired_row->full_width_p
666 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
667 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
668 width != 0)
669 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
670 height > 0))
671 {
672 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
673
674 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
675 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
676 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
677 y -= width;
678
679 BLOCK_INPUT;
680 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
681 0, y, width, height, False);
682 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
683 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
684 y, width, height, False);
685 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
686 }
687 }
688
689 static void
690 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
691 struct window *w;
692 struct glyph_row *row;
693 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
694 {
695 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
696 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
697 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
698 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
699 struct face *face = p->face;
700 int rowY;
701
702 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
703 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
704 if (p->y < rowY)
705 {
706 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
707 visible last row. */
708 int oldY = row->y;
709 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
710 row->visible_height = p->h;
711 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
712 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
713 row->y = oldY;
714 row->visible_height = oldVH;
715 }
716 else
717 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
718
719 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
720 {
721 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
722 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
723 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
724 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
725 if (face->stipple)
726 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
727 else
728 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
729
730 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
731 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
732
733 if (!face->stipple)
734 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
735 }
736
737 if (p->which)
738 {
739 unsigned char *bits;
740 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
741 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
742 XGCValues gcv;
743
744 if (p->wd > 8)
745 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
746 else
747 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
748
749 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
750 by the server. */
751 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
752 (p->cursor_p
753 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
754 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
755 : face->foreground),
756 face->background, depth);
757
758 if (p->overlay_p)
759 {
760 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
761 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
762 bits, p->wd, p->h,
763 1, 0, 1);
764 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
765 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
766 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
767 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
768 }
769
770 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
771 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
772 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
773
774 if (p->overlay_p)
775 {
776 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
777 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
778 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
779 }
780 }
781
782 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
783 }
784
785 \f
786
787 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
788 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
789 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
790 rarely happens). */
791
792 static void
793 XTset_terminal_modes ()
794 {
795 }
796
797 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
798 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
799
800 static void
801 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
802 {
803 }
804
805
806 \f
807 /***********************************************************************
808 Display Iterator
809 ***********************************************************************/
810
811 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
812
813 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
814
815
816 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
817 is not contained in the font. */
818
819 static XCharStruct *
820 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
821 XFontStruct *font;
822 XChar2b *char2b;
823 int font_type; /* unused on X */
824 {
825 /* The result metric information. */
826 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
827
828 xassert (font && char2b);
829
830 if (font->per_char != NULL)
831 {
832 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
833 {
834 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
835 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
836 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
837 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
838 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
839 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
840 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
841 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
842 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
843 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
844 }
845 else
846 {
847 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
848 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
849 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
850 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
851
852 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
853 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
854
855 where:
856
857 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
858 / = integer division
859 \ = integer modulus */
860 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
861 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
862 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
863 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
864 {
865 pcm = (font->per_char
866 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
867 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
868 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
869 }
870 }
871 }
872 else
873 {
874 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
875 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
876 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
877 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
878 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
879 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
880 }
881
882 return ((pcm == NULL
883 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
884 ? NULL : pcm);
885 }
886
887
888 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
889 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
890
891 static int
892 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
893 int c;
894 XChar2b *char2b;
895 struct font_info *font_info;
896 int *two_byte_p;
897 {
898 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
899 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
900
901 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
902 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
903 fixed encoding. */
904 if (font_info->font_encoder)
905 {
906 /* It's a program. */
907 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
908
909 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
910 {
911 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
912 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
913 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
914 }
915 else
916 {
917 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
918 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
919 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
920 }
921
922 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
923
924 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
925 program. */
926 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
927 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
928 else
929 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
930 }
931 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
932 {
933 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
934 encoding numbers. */
935 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
936
937 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
938 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
939 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
940
941 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
942 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
943 }
944
945 if (two_byte_p)
946 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
947
948 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
949 }
950
951
952 \f
953 /***********************************************************************
954 Glyph display
955 ***********************************************************************/
956
957
958
959 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
960 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
961 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
962 int));
963 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
964 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
965 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
967 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
968 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
972 unsigned long *, double, int));
973 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
974 double, int, unsigned long));
975 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
977 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
978 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
979 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
980 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
981 int, int, int));
982 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
983 int, int, int, int, int, int,
984 XRectangle *));
985 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
986 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
987
988 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
989 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
990 #endif
991
992
993 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
994 face. */
995
996 static void
997 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
998 struct glyph_string *s;
999 {
1000 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1001 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1002 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1003 && !s->cmp)
1004 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1005 else
1006 {
1007 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1008 XGCValues xgcv;
1009 unsigned long mask;
1010
1011 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1012 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1013
1014 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1015 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1016 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1017 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1018 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1019 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1020 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1021
1022 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1023 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1024 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1025 {
1026 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1027 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1028 }
1029
1030 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1031 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1032 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1033 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1034
1035 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1036 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1037 mask, &xgcv);
1038 else
1039 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1040 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1041
1042 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1043 }
1044 }
1045
1046
1047 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1048
1049 static void
1050 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1051 struct glyph_string *s;
1052 {
1053 int face_id;
1054 struct face *face;
1055
1056 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1057 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1058 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1059 if (face == NULL)
1060 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1061
1062 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1063 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1064 else
1065 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1066 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1067 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1068
1069 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1070 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1071 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1072 else
1073 {
1074 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1075 but font FONT. */
1076 XGCValues xgcv;
1077 unsigned long mask;
1078
1079 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1080 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1081 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1082 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1083 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1084 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1085
1086 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1087 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1088 mask, &xgcv);
1089 else
1090 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1091 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1092
1093 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1094 }
1095
1096 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1097 }
1098
1099
1100 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1101 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1102 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1103
1104 static INLINE void
1105 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1106 struct glyph_string *s;
1107 {
1108 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1109 }
1110
1111
1112 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1113 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1114 pattern. */
1115
1116 static INLINE void
1117 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1118 struct glyph_string *s;
1119 {
1120 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1121
1122 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1123 {
1124 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1125 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1126 }
1127 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1128 {
1129 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1130 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1131 }
1132 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1133 {
1134 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1135 s->stippled_p = 0;
1136 }
1137 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1138 {
1139 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1140 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1141 }
1142 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1143 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1144 {
1145 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1146 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1147 }
1148 else
1149 {
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1152 }
1153
1154 /* GC must have been set. */
1155 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1156 }
1157
1158
1159 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1160 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1161
1162 static INLINE void
1163 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1164 struct glyph_string *s;
1165 {
1166 XRectangle r;
1167 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1168 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1169 }
1170
1171
1172 /* RIF:
1173 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1174 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1175
1176 static void
1177 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1178 struct glyph_string *s;
1179 {
1180 if (s->cmp == NULL
1181 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1182 {
1183 XCharStruct cs;
1184 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1185 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1186 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1187 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1188 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1189 }
1190 }
1191
1192
1193 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1194
1195 static INLINE void
1196 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1197 struct glyph_string *s;
1198 int x, y, w, h;
1199 {
1200 XGCValues xgcv;
1201 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1202 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1203 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1204 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1205 }
1206
1207
1208 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1209 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1210 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1211 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1212 contains the first component of a composition. */
1213
1214 static void
1215 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1216 struct glyph_string *s;
1217 int force_p;
1218 {
1219 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1220 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1221 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1222 {
1223 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1224
1225 if (s->stippled_p)
1226 {
1227 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1228 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1229 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1230 s->y + box_line_width,
1231 s->background_width,
1232 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1233 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1234 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1235 }
1236 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1237 || s->font_not_found_p
1238 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1239 || force_p)
1240 {
1241 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1242 s->background_width,
1243 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1244 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1245 }
1246 }
1247 }
1248
1249
1250 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1251
1252 static void
1253 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1254 struct glyph_string *s;
1255 {
1256 int i, x;
1257
1258 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1259 of S to the right of that box line. */
1260 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1261 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1262 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1263 else
1264 x = s->x;
1265
1266 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1267 loaded. */
1268 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1269 {
1270 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1271 {
1272 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1273 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1274 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1275 s->height - 1);
1276 x += g->pixel_width;
1277 }
1278 }
1279 else
1280 {
1281 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1282 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1283
1284 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1285 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1286
1287 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1288 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1289 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1290 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1291
1292 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1293 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1294 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1295 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1296 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1297 if (s->for_overlaps_p
1298 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1299 {
1300 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1301 if (s->two_byte_p)
1302 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1303 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1304 else
1305 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1306 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1307 }
1308 else
1309 {
1310 if (s->two_byte_p)
1311 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1312 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1313 else
1314 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1315 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1316 }
1317
1318 if (s->face->overstrike)
1319 {
1320 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1321 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1322 if (s->two_byte_p)
1323 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1324 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1325 else
1326 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1327 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1328 }
1329 }
1330 }
1331
1332 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1333
1334 static void
1335 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1336 struct glyph_string *s;
1337 {
1338 int i, x;
1339
1340 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1341 of S to the right of that box line. */
1342 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1343 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1344 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1345 else
1346 x = s->x;
1347
1348 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1349 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1350 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1351 this composition. */
1352
1353 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1354 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1355 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1356 {
1357 if (s->gidx == 0)
1358 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1359 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1360 }
1361 else
1362 {
1363 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1364 {
1365 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1366 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1367 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1368 s->char2b + i, 1);
1369 if (s->face->overstrike)
1370 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1371 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1372 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1373 s->char2b + i, 1);
1374 }
1375 }
1376 }
1377
1378
1379 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1380
1381 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1382 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1383 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1384 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1385 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1386
1387
1388 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1389 cannot be determined. */
1390
1391 static struct frame *
1392 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1393 Widget widget;
1394 {
1395 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1396 Lisp_Object tail;
1397 struct frame *f;
1398
1399 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1400
1401 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1402 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1403 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1404 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1405 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1406 widget = XtParent (widget);
1407
1408 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1409 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1410 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1411 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1412 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1413 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1414 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1415 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1416 return f;
1417
1418 abort ();
1419 }
1420
1421
1422 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1423 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1424 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1425 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1426
1427 int
1428 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1429 Widget widget;
1430 Colormap cmap;
1431 XColor *color;
1432 {
1433 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1434 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1435 }
1436
1437
1438 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1439 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1440 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1441 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1442 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1443 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1444
1445 int
1446 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1447 Widget widget;
1448 Display *display;
1449 Colormap cmap;
1450 unsigned long *pixel;
1451 double factor;
1452 int delta;
1453 {
1454 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1455 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1456 }
1457
1458
1459 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1460 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1461
1462 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1463 {
1464 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1465 sizeof (Screen *)},
1466 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1467 sizeof (Colormap)}
1468 };
1469
1470
1471 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1472 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1473
1474 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1475
1476
1477 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1478
1479 DPY is the display we are working on.
1480
1481 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1482 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1483 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1484 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1485
1486 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1487 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1488
1489 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1490 we allocated the color or not.
1491
1492 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1493
1494 static Boolean
1495 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1496 Display *dpy;
1497 XrmValue *args;
1498 Cardinal *nargs;
1499 XrmValue *from, *to;
1500 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1501 {
1502 Screen *screen;
1503 Colormap cmap;
1504 Pixel pixel;
1505 String color_name;
1506 XColor color;
1507
1508 if (*nargs != 2)
1509 {
1510 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1511 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1512 "XtToolkitError",
1513 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1514 return False;
1515 }
1516
1517 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1518 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1519 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1520
1521 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1522 {
1523 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1524 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1525 }
1526 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1527 {
1528 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1529 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1530 }
1531 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1532 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1533 {
1534 pixel = color.pixel;
1535 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1536 }
1537 else
1538 {
1539 String params[1];
1540 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1541
1542 params[0] = color_name;
1543 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1544 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1545 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1546 params, &nparams);
1547 return False;
1548 }
1549
1550 if (to->addr != NULL)
1551 {
1552 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1553 {
1554 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1555 return False;
1556 }
1557
1558 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1559 }
1560 else
1561 {
1562 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1563 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1564 }
1565
1566 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1567 return True;
1568 }
1569
1570
1571 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1572 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1573 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1574
1575 APP is the application context in which we work.
1576
1577 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1578 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1579 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1580
1581 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1582
1583 static void
1584 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1585 XtAppContext app;
1586 XrmValuePtr to;
1587 XtPointer closure;
1588 XrmValuePtr args;
1589 Cardinal *nargs;
1590 {
1591 if (*nargs != 2)
1592 {
1593 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1594 "XtToolkitError",
1595 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1596 NULL, NULL);
1597 }
1598 else if (closure != NULL)
1599 {
1600 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1601 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1602 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1603 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1604 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1605 }
1606 }
1607
1608
1609 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1610
1611
1612 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1613 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1614 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1615 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1616
1617 static const XColor *
1618 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1619 Display *dpy;
1620 int *ncells;
1621 {
1622 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1623
1624 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1625 {
1626 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1627 int i;
1628
1629 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1630 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1631 dpyinfo->color_cells
1632 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1633 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1634
1635 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1637
1638 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1639 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1640 }
1641
1642 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1643 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1644 }
1645
1646
1647 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1648 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1649
1650 void
1651 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1652 struct frame *f;
1653 XColor *colors;
1654 int ncolors;
1655 {
1656 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1657
1658 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1659 {
1660 int i;
1661 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1662 {
1663 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1664 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1665 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1666 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1667 }
1668 }
1669 else
1670 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1671 }
1672
1673
1674 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1675 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1676
1677 void
1678 x_query_color (f, color)
1679 struct frame *f;
1680 XColor *color;
1681 {
1682 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1683 }
1684
1685
1686 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1687 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1688 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1689 allocated. */
1690
1691 static int
1692 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1693 Display *dpy;
1694 Colormap cmap;
1695 XColor *color;
1696 {
1697 int rc;
1698
1699 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1700 if (rc == 0)
1701 {
1702 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1703 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1704 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1705 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1706 int nearest, i;
1707 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1708 int ncells;
1709 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1710
1711 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1712 {
1713 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1714 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1715 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1716 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1717
1718 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1719 {
1720 nearest = i;
1721 nearest_delta = delta;
1722 }
1723 }
1724
1725 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1726 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1727 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1728 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1729 }
1730 else
1731 {
1732 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1733 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1734 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1735 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1736 XColor *cached_color;
1737
1738 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1739 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1740 (cached_color->red != color->red
1741 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1742 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1743 {
1744 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1745 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1746 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1747 }
1748 }
1749
1750 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1751 if (rc)
1752 register_color (color->pixel);
1753 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1754
1755 return rc;
1756 }
1757
1758
1759 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1760 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1761 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1762 allocated. */
1763
1764 int
1765 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1766 struct frame *f;
1767 Colormap cmap;
1768 XColor *color;
1769 {
1770 gamma_correct (f, color);
1771 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1772 }
1773
1774
1775 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1776 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1777 get color reference counts right. */
1778
1779 unsigned long
1780 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1781 struct frame *f;
1782 unsigned long pixel;
1783 {
1784 XColor color;
1785
1786 color.pixel = pixel;
1787 BLOCK_INPUT;
1788 x_query_color (f, &color);
1789 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1790 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1791 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1792 register_color (pixel);
1793 #endif
1794 return color.pixel;
1795 }
1796
1797
1798 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1799 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1800 get color reference counts right. */
1801
1802 unsigned long
1803 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1804 Display *dpy;
1805 Colormap cmap;
1806 unsigned long pixel;
1807 {
1808 XColor color;
1809
1810 color.pixel = pixel;
1811 BLOCK_INPUT;
1812 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1813 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1814 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1815 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1816 register_color (pixel);
1817 #endif
1818 return color.pixel;
1819 }
1820
1821
1822 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1823 boosted.
1824
1825 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1826 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1827 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1828 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1829 use an additional additive factor.
1830
1831 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1832 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1833 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1834
1835
1836 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1837 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1838 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1839 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1840 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1841 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1842
1843 static int
1844 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1845 struct frame *f;
1846 Display *display;
1847 Colormap cmap;
1848 unsigned long *pixel;
1849 double factor;
1850 int delta;
1851 {
1852 XColor color, new;
1853 long bright;
1854 int success_p;
1855
1856 /* Get RGB color values. */
1857 color.pixel = *pixel;
1858 x_query_color (f, &color);
1859
1860 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1861 xassert (factor >= 0);
1862 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1863 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1864 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1865
1866 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1867 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1868
1869 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1870 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1871 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1872 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1873 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1874 {
1875 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1876 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1877 /* The additive adjustment. */
1878 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1879
1880 if (factor < 1)
1881 {
1882 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1883 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1884 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1885 }
1886 else
1887 {
1888 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1889 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1890 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1891 }
1892 }
1893
1894 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1895 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1896 if (success_p)
1897 {
1898 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1899 {
1900 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1901 delta to the RGB values. */
1902 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1903
1904 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1905 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1906 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1907 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1908 }
1909 else
1910 success_p = 1;
1911 *pixel = new.pixel;
1912 }
1913
1914 return success_p;
1915 }
1916
1917
1918 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1919 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1920 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1921 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1922 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1923 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1924
1925 static void
1926 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1927 struct frame *f;
1928 struct relief *relief;
1929 double factor;
1930 int delta;
1931 unsigned long default_pixel;
1932 {
1933 XGCValues xgcv;
1934 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1935 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1936 unsigned long pixel;
1937 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1938 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1939 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1940 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1941
1942 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1943 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1944
1945 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1946 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1947 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1948 if (relief->gc
1949 && relief->allocated_p)
1950 {
1951 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1952 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1953 }
1954
1955 /* Allocate new color. */
1956 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1957 pixel = background;
1958 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1959 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1960 {
1961 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1962 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1963 }
1964
1965 if (relief->gc == 0)
1966 {
1967 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1968 mask |= GCStipple;
1969 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1970 }
1971 else
1972 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1973 }
1974
1975
1976 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1977
1978 static void
1979 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1980 struct glyph_string *s;
1981 {
1982 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1983 unsigned long color;
1984
1985 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1986 color = s->face->box_color;
1987 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1988 && s->img->pixmap
1989 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1990 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1991 else
1992 {
1993 XGCValues xgcv;
1994
1995 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1996 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1997 color = xgcv.background;
1998 }
1999
2000 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2001 || color != di->relief_background)
2002 {
2003 di->relief_background = color;
2004 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2005 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2006 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2007 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2008 }
2009 }
2010
2011
2012 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2013 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2014 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2015 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2016 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2017 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2018 when drawing. */
2019
2020 static void
2021 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2022 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2023 struct frame *f;
2024 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2025 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2026 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2027 {
2028 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2029 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2030 int i;
2031 GC gc;
2032
2033 if (raised_p)
2034 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2035 else
2036 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2037 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2038
2039 /* Top. */
2040 if (top_p)
2041 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2042 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2043 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2044 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2045
2046 /* Left. */
2047 if (left_p)
2048 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2050 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2051
2052 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2053 if (raised_p)
2054 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2055 else
2056 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2057 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2058
2059 /* Bottom. */
2060 if (bot_p)
2061 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2062 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2063 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2064 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2065
2066 /* Right. */
2067 if (right_p)
2068 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2069 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2070 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2071
2072 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2073 }
2074
2075
2076 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2077 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2078 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2079 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2080 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2081 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2082
2083 static void
2084 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2085 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2086 struct glyph_string *s;
2087 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2088 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2089 {
2090 XGCValues xgcv;
2091
2092 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2093 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2094 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2095
2096 /* Top. */
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2099
2100 /* Left. */
2101 if (left_p)
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2104
2105 /* Bottom. */
2106 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2107 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2108
2109 /* Right. */
2110 if (right_p)
2111 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2112 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2113
2114 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2115 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2116 }
2117
2118
2119 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2120
2121 static void
2122 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2123 struct glyph_string *s;
2124 {
2125 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2126 int left_p, right_p;
2127 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2128 XRectangle clip_rect;
2129
2130 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
2131 if (s->row->full_width_p
2132 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2133 {
2134 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (s->w);
2135 if (s->area != RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
2136 || WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (s->w))
2137 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->w);
2138 }
2139
2140 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2141 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2142 ? s->first_glyph
2143 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2144
2145 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2146 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2147 left_x = s->x;
2148 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2149 ? last_x - 1
2150 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2151 top_y = s->y;
2152 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2153
2154 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2155 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2156 && (s->prev == NULL
2157 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2158 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2159 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2160 && (s->next == NULL
2161 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2162
2163 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2164
2165 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2166 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2167 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2168 else
2169 {
2170 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2171 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2172 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2173 }
2174 }
2175
2176
2177 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2178
2179 static void
2180 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2181 struct glyph_string *s;
2182 {
2183 int x = s->x;
2184 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2185
2186 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2187 right of that line. */
2188 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2189 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2190 && s->slice.x == 0)
2191 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2192
2193 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2194 by that margin. */
2195 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2196 x += s->img->hmargin;
2197 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2198 y += s->img->vmargin;
2199
2200 if (s->img->pixmap)
2201 {
2202 if (s->img->mask)
2203 {
2204 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2205 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2206 trust on the shape extension to be available
2207 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2208 manually. */
2209 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2210 | GCFunction);
2211 XGCValues xgcv;
2212 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2213
2214 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2215 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2216 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2217 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2218 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2219
2220 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2221 image_rect.x = x;
2222 image_rect.y = y;
2223 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2224 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2225 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2226 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2227 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2228 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2229 }
2230 else
2231 {
2232 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2233
2234 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2235 image_rect.x = x;
2236 image_rect.y = y;
2237 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2238 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2239 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2240 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2241 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2242 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2243
2244 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2245 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2246 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2247 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2248 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2249 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2250 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2251 {
2252 int r = s->img->relief;
2253 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2254 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2255 x - r, y - r,
2256 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2257 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2258 }
2259 }
2260 }
2261 else
2262 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2263 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2264 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2265 }
2266
2267
2268 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2269
2270 static void
2271 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2272 struct glyph_string *s;
2273 {
2274 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2275 XRectangle r;
2276 int x = s->x;
2277 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2278
2279 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2280 right of that line. */
2281 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2282 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2283 && s->slice.x == 0)
2284 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2285
2286 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2287 by that margin. */
2288 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2289 x += s->img->hmargin;
2290 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2291 y += s->img->vmargin;
2292
2293 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2294 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2295 {
2296 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2297 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2298 }
2299 else
2300 {
2301 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2302 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2303 }
2304
2305 x0 = x - thick;
2306 y0 = y - thick;
2307 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2308 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2309
2310 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2311 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2312 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2313 s->slice.y == 0,
2314 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2315 s->slice.x == 0,
2316 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2317 &r);
2318 }
2319
2320
2321 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2322
2323 static void
2324 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2325 struct glyph_string *s;
2326 Pixmap pixmap;
2327 {
2328 int x = 0;
2329 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2330
2331 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2332 right of that line. */
2333 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2334 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2335 && s->slice.x == 0)
2336 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2337
2338 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2339 by that margin. */
2340 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2341 x += s->img->hmargin;
2342 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2343 y += s->img->vmargin;
2344
2345 if (s->img->pixmap)
2346 {
2347 if (s->img->mask)
2348 {
2349 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2350 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2351 trust on the shape extension to be available
2352 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2353 manually. */
2354 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2355 | GCFunction);
2356 XGCValues xgcv;
2357
2358 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2359 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2360 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2361 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2362 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2363
2364 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2365 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2366 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2367 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2368 }
2369 else
2370 {
2371 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2372 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2373 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2374
2375 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2376 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2377 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2378 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2379 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2380 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2381 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2382 {
2383 int r = s->img->relief;
2384 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2385 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2386 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2387 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2388 }
2389 }
2390 }
2391 else
2392 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2393 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2394 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2395 }
2396
2397
2398 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2399 give the rectangle to draw. */
2400
2401 static void
2402 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2403 struct glyph_string *s;
2404 int x, y, w, h;
2405 {
2406 if (s->stippled_p)
2407 {
2408 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2409 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2410 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2411 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2412 }
2413 else
2414 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2415 }
2416
2417
2418 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2419
2420 s->y
2421 s->x +-------------------------
2422 | s->face->box
2423 |
2424 | +-------------------------
2425 | | s->img->margin
2426 | |
2427 | | +-------------------
2428 | | | the image
2429
2430 */
2431
2432 static void
2433 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2434 struct glyph_string *s;
2435 {
2436 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2437 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2438 int height;
2439 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2440
2441 height = s->height;
2442 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2443 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2444 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2445 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2446
2447 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2448 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2449 flickering. */
2450 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2451 if (height > s->slice.height
2452 || s->img->hmargin
2453 || s->img->vmargin
2454 || s->img->mask
2455 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2456 || s->width != s->background_width)
2457 {
2458 if (s->img->mask)
2459 {
2460 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2461 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2462 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2463 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2464 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2465
2466 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2467 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2468 s->background_width,
2469 s->height, depth);
2470
2471 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2472 pixmap. */
2473 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2474
2475 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2476 if (s->stippled_p)
2477 {
2478 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2479 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2480 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2481 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2482 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2483 }
2484 else
2485 {
2486 XGCValues xgcv;
2487 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2488 &xgcv);
2489 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2490 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2491 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2492 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2493 }
2494 }
2495 else
2496 {
2497 int x = s->x;
2498 int y = s->y;
2499
2500 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2501 && s->slice.x == 0)
2502 x += box_line_hwidth;
2503
2504 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2505 y += box_line_vwidth;
2506
2507 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2508 }
2509
2510 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2511 }
2512
2513 /* Draw the foreground. */
2514 if (pixmap != None)
2515 {
2516 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2517 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2518 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2519 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2520 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2521 }
2522 else
2523 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2524
2525 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2526 if (s->img->relief
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2528 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2529 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2530 }
2531
2532
2533 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2534
2535 static void
2536 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2537 struct glyph_string *s;
2538 {
2539 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2540 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2541
2542 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2543 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2544 {
2545 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2546 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2547 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2548
2549 /* Draw cursor. */
2550 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2551
2552 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2553 if (width < s->background_width)
2554 {
2555 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2556 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2557 XRectangle r;
2558 GC gc;
2559
2560 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2561 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2562 {
2563 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2564 gc = s->gc;
2565 }
2566 else
2567 gc = s->face->gc;
2568
2569 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2570 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2571
2572 if (s->face->stipple)
2573 {
2574 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2575 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2576 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2577 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2578 }
2579 else
2580 {
2581 XGCValues xgcv;
2582 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2583 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2584 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2585 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2586 }
2587 }
2588 }
2589 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2590 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2591 s->height);
2592
2593 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2594 }
2595
2596
2597 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2598
2599 static void
2600 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2601 struct glyph_string *s;
2602 {
2603 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2604
2605 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2606 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2607 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2608 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
2609 {
2610 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2611 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2612 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2613 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2614 }
2615
2616 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2617 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2618
2619 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2620 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2621 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
2622 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2623 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2624 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2625
2626 {
2627 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2629 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2630 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2631 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2632 }
2633 else
2634 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2635
2636 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2637 {
2638 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2639 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2640 break;
2641
2642 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2643 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2644 break;
2645
2646 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2647 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2648 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2649 else
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2651 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2652 break;
2653
2654 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2655 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
2656 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2657 else
2658 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2659 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2660 break;
2661
2662 default:
2663 abort ();
2664 }
2665
2666 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
2667 {
2668 /* Draw underline. */
2669 if (s->face->underline_p)
2670 {
2671 unsigned long tem, h;
2672 int y;
2673
2674 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2675 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2676 h = 1;
2677
2678 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2679 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2680 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2681 specs, and its default is
2682
2683 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2684 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2685
2686 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2687 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2688 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2689 else if (s->face->font)
2690 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2691 else
2692 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2693
2694 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2695 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2696 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2697 else
2698 {
2699 XGCValues xgcv;
2700 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2701 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2702 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2703 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2704 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2705 }
2706 }
2707
2708 /* Draw overline. */
2709 if (s->face->overline_p)
2710 {
2711 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2712
2713 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2714 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2715 s->width, h);
2716 else
2717 {
2718 XGCValues xgcv;
2719 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2720 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2721 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2722 s->width, h);
2723 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2724 }
2725 }
2726
2727 /* Draw strike-through. */
2728 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2729 {
2730 unsigned long h = 1;
2731 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2732
2733 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2734 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2735 s->width, h);
2736 else
2737 {
2738 XGCValues xgcv;
2739 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2740 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2741 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2742 s->width, h);
2743 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2744 }
2745 }
2746
2747 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2748 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2749 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2750 }
2751
2752 /* Reset clipping. */
2753 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2754 }
2755
2756 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2757
2758 void
2759 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2760 struct frame *f;
2761 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2762 {
2763 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2764 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2765 x, y, width, height,
2766 x + shift_by, y);
2767 }
2768
2769 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2770 for X frames. */
2771
2772 static void
2773 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2774 register int n;
2775 {
2776 abort ();
2777 }
2778
2779
2780 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2781 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2782
2783 void
2784 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2785 Display *dpy;
2786 Window window;
2787 int x, y;
2788 int width, height;
2789 int exposures;
2790 {
2791 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2792 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2793 }
2794
2795
2796 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2797 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2798
2799 static void
2800 x_clear_frame ()
2801 {
2802 struct frame *f;
2803
2804 if (updating_frame)
2805 f = updating_frame;
2806 else
2807 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2808
2809 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2810 longer visible. */
2811 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2812 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2813 output_cursor.x = -1;
2814
2815 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2816 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2817 BLOCK_INPUT;
2818 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2819
2820 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2821 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2822 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2823
2824 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2825
2826 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2827 }
2828
2829
2830 \f
2831 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2832
2833 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2834 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2835
2836 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2837
2838
2839 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2840 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2841
2842 static int
2843 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2844 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2845 {
2846 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2847 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2848 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2849 {
2850 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2851 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2852 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2853 }
2854
2855 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2856 {
2857 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2858 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2859 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2860 }
2861
2862 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2863 positive. */
2864 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2865 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2866
2867 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2868 negative. */
2869 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2870 }
2871
2872 void
2873 XTflash (f)
2874 struct frame *f;
2875 {
2876 BLOCK_INPUT;
2877
2878 {
2879 GC gc;
2880
2881 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2882 pixels into background pixels. */
2883 {
2884 XGCValues values;
2885
2886 values.function = GXxor;
2887 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2888 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2889
2890 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2891 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2892 }
2893
2894 {
2895 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2896 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2897 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2898 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2899 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2900 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2901 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2902
2903 int width;
2904
2905 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2906 edge it is next to. */
2907 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2908 {
2909 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2910 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2911 break;
2912
2913 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2914 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2915 break;
2916
2917 default:
2918 break;
2919 }
2920
2921 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2922
2923 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2924 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2925 {
2926 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2927 flash_left,
2928 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2929 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2930 width, flash_height);
2931 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2932 flash_left,
2933 (height - flash_height
2934 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2935 width, flash_height);
2936 }
2937 else
2938 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2939 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2940 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2941 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2942
2943 x_flush (f);
2944
2945 {
2946 struct timeval wakeup;
2947
2948 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2949
2950 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2951 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2952 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2953 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2954
2955 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2956 available. */
2957 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2958 {
2959 struct timeval current;
2960 struct timeval timeout;
2961
2962 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2963
2964 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2965 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2966 break;
2967
2968 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2969 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2970 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2971
2972 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2973 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2974 }
2975 }
2976
2977 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2978 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2979 {
2980 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2981 flash_left,
2982 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2983 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2984 width, flash_height);
2985 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2986 flash_left,
2987 (height - flash_height
2988 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2989 width, flash_height);
2990 }
2991 else
2992 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2993 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2994 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2995 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2996
2997 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2998 x_flush (f);
2999 }
3000 }
3001
3002 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3003 }
3004
3005 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3006
3007
3008 /* Make audible bell. */
3009
3010 void
3011 XTring_bell ()
3012 {
3013 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3014
3015 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3016 {
3017 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3018 if (visible_bell)
3019 XTflash (f);
3020 else
3021 #endif
3022 {
3023 BLOCK_INPUT;
3024 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3025 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3026 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3027 }
3028 }
3029 }
3030
3031 \f
3032 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3033 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3034 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3035 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3036
3037 static void
3038 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3039 register int n;
3040 {
3041 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3042 }
3043
3044
3045 \f
3046 /***********************************************************************
3047 Line Dance
3048 ***********************************************************************/
3049
3050 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3051 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3052
3053 static void
3054 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3055 int vpos, n;
3056 {
3057 abort ();
3058 }
3059
3060
3061 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3062
3063 static void
3064 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3065 struct window *w;
3066 struct run *run;
3067 {
3068 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3069 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3070
3071 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3072 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3073 fringe of W. */
3074 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3075
3076 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3077 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3078 bottom_y = y + height;
3079
3080 if (to_y < from_y)
3081 {
3082 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3083 line at the bottom. */
3084 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3085 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3086 else
3087 height = run->height;
3088 }
3089 else
3090 {
3091 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3092 at the bottom. */
3093 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3094 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3095 else
3096 height = run->height;
3097 }
3098
3099 BLOCK_INPUT;
3100
3101 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3102 updated_window = w;
3103 x_clear_cursor (w);
3104
3105 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3106 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3107 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3108 x, from_y,
3109 width, height,
3110 x, to_y);
3111
3112 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3113 }
3114
3115
3116 \f
3117 /***********************************************************************
3118 Exposure Events
3119 ***********************************************************************/
3120
3121 \f
3122 static void
3123 frame_highlight (f)
3124 struct frame *f;
3125 {
3126 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3127 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3128 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3129 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3130 BLOCK_INPUT;
3131 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3132 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3133 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3134 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3135 }
3136
3137 static void
3138 frame_unhighlight (f)
3139 struct frame *f;
3140 {
3141 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3142 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3143 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3144 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3145 BLOCK_INPUT;
3146 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3147 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3148 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3149 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3150 }
3151
3152 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3153 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3154 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3155 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3156 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3157
3158 static void
3159 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3160 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3161 struct frame *frame;
3162 {
3163 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3164
3165 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3166 {
3167 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3168 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3169 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3170
3171 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3172 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3173
3174 #if 0
3175 selected_frame = frame;
3176 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3177 selected_frame);
3178 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3179 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3180 #endif /* ! 0 */
3181
3182 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3183 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3184 else
3185 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3186 }
3187
3188 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3189 }
3190
3191 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3192 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3193 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3194
3195 static void
3196 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3197 int type;
3198 int state;
3199 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3200 struct frame *frame;
3201 struct input_event *bufp;
3202 {
3203 if (type == FocusIn)
3204 {
3205 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3206 {
3207 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3208 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3209
3210 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3211 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3212 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3213 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3214 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3215 {
3216 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3217 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3218 }
3219 }
3220
3221 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3222
3223 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3224 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3225 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3226 #endif
3227 }
3228 else if (type == FocusOut)
3229 {
3230 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3231
3232 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3233 {
3234 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3235 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3236 }
3237
3238 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3239 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3240 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3241 #endif
3242 }
3243 }
3244
3245 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3246 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3247
3248 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3249
3250 static void
3251 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3252 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3253 XEvent *event;
3254 struct input_event *bufp;
3255 {
3256 struct frame *frame;
3257
3258 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3259 if (! frame)
3260 return;
3261
3262 switch (event->type)
3263 {
3264 case EnterNotify:
3265 case LeaveNotify:
3266 {
3267 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3268 int focus_state
3269 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3270
3271 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3272 && event->xcrossing.focus
3273 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3274 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3275 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3276 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3277 }
3278 break;
3279
3280 case FocusIn:
3281 case FocusOut:
3282 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3283 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3284 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3285 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3286 break;
3287 }
3288 }
3289
3290
3291 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3292
3293 void
3294 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3295 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3296 {
3297 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3298 }
3299
3300 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3301 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3302 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3303
3304 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3305 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3306 the appropriate X display info. */
3307
3308 static void
3309 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3310 struct frame *frame;
3311 {
3312 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3313 }
3314
3315 static void
3316 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3317 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3318 {
3319 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3320
3321 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3322 {
3323 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3324 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3325 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3326 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3327 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3328 {
3329 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3330 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3331 }
3332 }
3333 else
3334 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3335
3336 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3337 {
3338 if (old_highlight)
3339 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3340 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3341 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3342 }
3343 }
3344
3345
3346 \f
3347 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3348
3349 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3350 static void
3351 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3352 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3353 {
3354 int min_code, max_code;
3355 KeySym *syms;
3356 int syms_per_code;
3357 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3358
3359 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3360 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3361 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3362 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3363 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3364
3365 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3366 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3367 #else
3368 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3369 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3370 #endif
3371
3372 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3373 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3374 &syms_per_code);
3375 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3376
3377 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3378 Alt keysyms are on. */
3379 {
3380 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3381 int found_alt_or_meta;
3382
3383 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3384 {
3385 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3386 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3387 {
3388 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3389
3390 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3391 if (code == 0)
3392 continue;
3393
3394 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3395 {
3396 int code_col;
3397
3398 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3399 {
3400 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3401
3402 switch (sym)
3403 {
3404 case XK_Meta_L:
3405 case XK_Meta_R:
3406 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3407 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3408 break;
3409
3410 case XK_Alt_L:
3411 case XK_Alt_R:
3412 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3413 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3414 break;
3415
3416 case XK_Hyper_L:
3417 case XK_Hyper_R:
3418 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3419 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3420 code_col = syms_per_code;
3421 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3422 break;
3423
3424 case XK_Super_L:
3425 case XK_Super_R:
3426 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3427 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3428 code_col = syms_per_code;
3429 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3430 break;
3431
3432 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3433 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3434 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3435 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3436 code_col = syms_per_code;
3437 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3438 break;
3439 }
3440 }
3441 }
3442 }
3443 }
3444 }
3445
3446 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3447 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3448 {
3449 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3450 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3451 }
3452
3453 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3454 make them just meta, not alt. */
3455 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3456 {
3457 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3458 }
3459
3460 XFree ((char *) syms);
3461 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3462 }
3463
3464 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3465 Emacs uses. */
3466
3467 static unsigned int
3468 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3469 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3470 unsigned int state;
3471 {
3472 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3473 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3474 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3475 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3476 Lisp_Object tem;
3477
3478 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3479 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3480 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3481 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3482 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3483 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3484 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3485 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3486
3487
3488 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3489 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3490 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3491 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3492 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3493 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3494 }
3495
3496 static unsigned int
3497 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3498 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3499 unsigned int state;
3500 {
3501 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3502 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3503 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3504 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3505
3506 Lisp_Object tem;
3507
3508 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3509 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3510 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3511 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3512 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3513 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3514 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3515 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3516
3517
3518 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3519 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3520 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3521 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3522 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3523 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3524 }
3525
3526 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3527
3528 char *
3529 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3530 KeySym keysym;
3531 {
3532 char *value;
3533
3534 BLOCK_INPUT;
3535 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3536 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3537
3538 return value;
3539 }
3540
3541
3542 \f
3543 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3544
3545 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3546
3547 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3548 the mouse. */
3549
3550 static Lisp_Object
3551 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3552 struct input_event *result;
3553 XButtonEvent *event;
3554 struct frame *f;
3555 {
3556 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3557 otherwise. */
3558 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3559 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3560 result->timestamp = event->time;
3561 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3562 event->state)
3563 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3564 ? up_modifier
3565 : down_modifier));
3566
3567 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3568 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3569 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3570 result->arg = Qnil;
3571 return Qnil;
3572 }
3573
3574 \f
3575 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3576 The input handler calls this.
3577
3578 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3579 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3580 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3581 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3582
3583 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3584 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3585
3586 static void
3587 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3588 FRAME_PTR frame;
3589 XMotionEvent *event;
3590 {
3591 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3592 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3593 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3594
3595 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3596 {
3597 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3598 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3599 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3600 }
3601
3602 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3603 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3604 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3605 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3606 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3607 {
3608 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3609 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3610 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3611 }
3612 }
3613
3614 \f
3615 /************************************************************************
3616 Mouse Face
3617 ************************************************************************/
3618
3619 static void
3620 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3621 {
3622 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3623 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3624 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3625 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3626 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3627 }
3628
3629
3630 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
3631
3632
3633 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
3634 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
3635 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
3636 values. */
3637
3638 static int
3639 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
3640 struct frame *f;
3641 int x, y;
3642 XRectangle *rect;
3643 {
3644 Lisp_Object window;
3645 struct window *w;
3646 struct glyph_row *r, *end_row;
3647
3648 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, &x, &y, 0);
3649 if (NILP (window))
3650 return 0;
3651
3652 w = XWINDOW (window);
3653 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
3654 end_row = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
3655
3656 for (; r < end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
3657 {
3658 if (r->y >= y)
3659 {
3660 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
3661 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
3662 int gx = r->x;
3663 while (g < end && gx < x)
3664 gx += g->pixel_width, ++g;
3665 if (g < end)
3666 {
3667 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
3668 rect->height = r->height;
3669 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
3670 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
3671 return 1;
3672 }
3673 break;
3674 }
3675 }
3676
3677 return 0;
3678 }
3679
3680
3681 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3682 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3683
3684 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3685 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3686 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3687 position on the scroll bar.
3688
3689 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3690 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3691 the mouse is over.
3692
3693 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3694 was at this position.
3695
3696 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3697
3698 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3699 movement. */
3700
3701 static void
3702 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3703 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3704 int insist;
3705 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3706 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3707 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3708 unsigned long *time;
3709 {
3710 FRAME_PTR f1;
3711
3712 BLOCK_INPUT;
3713
3714 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3715 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3716 else
3717 {
3718 Window root;
3719 int root_x, root_y;
3720
3721 Window dummy_window;
3722 int dummy;
3723
3724 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3725
3726 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3727 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3728 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3729 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3730
3731 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3732
3733 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3734 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3735 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3736
3737 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3738 &root,
3739
3740 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3741 a different screen. */
3742 &dummy_window,
3743
3744 /* The position on that root window. */
3745 &root_x, &root_y,
3746
3747 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3748 &dummy, &dummy,
3749
3750 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3751 we don't care. */
3752 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3753
3754 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3755 containing the pointer. */
3756 {
3757 Window win, child;
3758 int win_x, win_y;
3759 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3760 int count;
3761
3762 win = root;
3763
3764 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3765 structure is changing at the same time this function
3766 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3767
3768 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3769
3770 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3771 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3772 {
3773 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3774 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3775 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3776
3777 /* From-window, to-window. */
3778 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3779
3780 /* From-position, to-position. */
3781 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3782
3783 /* Child of win. */
3784 &child);
3785 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3786 }
3787 else
3788 {
3789 while (1)
3790 {
3791 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3792
3793 /* From-window, to-window. */
3794 root, win,
3795
3796 /* From-position, to-position. */
3797 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3798
3799 /* Child of win. */
3800 &child);
3801
3802 if (child == None || child == win)
3803 break;
3804
3805 win = child;
3806 parent_x = win_x;
3807 parent_y = win_y;
3808 }
3809
3810 /* Now we know that:
3811 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3812 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3813 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3814 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3815 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3816 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3817 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3818 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3819 never use them in that case.) */
3820
3821 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3822 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3823
3824 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3825 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3826 on the frame. */
3827 if (f1 != NULL
3828 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3829 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3830 f1 = NULL;
3831 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3832 }
3833
3834 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3835 f1 = 0;
3836
3837 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3838
3839 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3840 if (! f1)
3841 {
3842 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3843
3844 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3845
3846 if (bar)
3847 {
3848 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3849 win_x = parent_x;
3850 win_y = parent_y;
3851 }
3852 }
3853
3854 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3855 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3856
3857 if (f1)
3858 {
3859 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3860 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3861 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3862 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3863 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3864 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3865 the frame are divided into. */
3866
3867 int width, height, gx, gy;
3868 XRectangle rect;
3869
3870 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
3871 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
3872 else
3873 {
3874 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
3875 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
3876 gx = win_x;
3877 gy = win_y;
3878
3879 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
3880 round down even for negative values. */
3881 if (gx < 0)
3882 gx -= width - 1;
3883 if (gy < 0)
3884 gy -= height - 1;
3885 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
3886 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
3887
3888 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
3889 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
3890 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
3891 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
3892 }
3893
3894 *bar_window = Qnil;
3895 *part = 0;
3896 *fp = f1;
3897 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3898 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3899 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3900 }
3901 }
3902 }
3903
3904 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3905 }
3906
3907
3908 \f
3909 /***********************************************************************
3910 Scroll bars
3911 ***********************************************************************/
3912
3913 /* Scroll bar support. */
3914
3915 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3916 manages it.
3917 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3918 bits. */
3919
3920 static struct scroll_bar *
3921 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3922 Display *display;
3923 Window window_id;
3924 {
3925 Lisp_Object tail;
3926
3927 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3928 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3929 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3930
3931 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3932 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3933 tail = XCDR (tail))
3934 {
3935 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3936
3937 frame = XCAR (tail);
3938 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3939 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3940 abort ();
3941
3942 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3943 right window ID. */
3944 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3945 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3946 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3947 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3948 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3949 condemned = Qnil,
3950 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3951 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3952 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3953 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3954 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3955 }
3956
3957 return 0;
3958 }
3959
3960
3961 #if defined USE_LUCID
3962
3963 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3964 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3965
3966 static Widget
3967 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3968 Window window;
3969 {
3970 Lisp_Object tail;
3971
3972 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3973 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3974 tail = XCDR (tail))
3975 {
3976 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3977 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3978
3979 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3980 return menu_bar;
3981 }
3982
3983 return NULL;
3984 }
3985
3986 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3987
3988 \f
3989 /************************************************************************
3990 Toolkit scroll bars
3991 ************************************************************************/
3992
3993 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3994
3995 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3996 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3997 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3998 struct scroll_bar *));
3999 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
4000 int, int, int));
4001
4002
4003 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4004 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4005
4006 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4007
4008 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4009
4010 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4011
4012 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4013 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4014
4015 #ifndef USE_GTK
4016 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4017
4018 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4019
4020 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4021
4022 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4023 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4024 to avoid jerkyness. */
4025
4026 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4027
4028 extern void set_vertical_scroll_bar P_ ((struct window *));
4029
4030 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4031 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4032 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4033 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4034
4035 static void
4036 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
4037 num_params)
4038 Widget widget;
4039 XtPointer client_data;
4040 String action_name;
4041 XEvent *event;
4042 String *params;
4043 Cardinal *num_params;
4044 {
4045 int scroll_bar_p;
4046 char *end_action;
4047
4048 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4049 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4050 end_action = "Release";
4051 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4052 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4053 end_action = "EndScroll";
4054 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4055
4056 if (scroll_bar_p
4057 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4058 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4059 {
4060 struct window *w;
4061
4062 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4063 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4064 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4065
4066 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4067 {
4068 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4069 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4070 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4071 }
4072 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4073 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4074
4075 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4076 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4077 }
4078 }
4079 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4080
4081 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4082 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4083
4084 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4085 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4086
4087
4088 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4089 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4090 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4091 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4092
4093 static void
4094 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4095 Lisp_Object window;
4096 int part, portion, whole;
4097 {
4098 XEvent event;
4099 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4100 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4101 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4102 int i;
4103
4104 BLOCK_INPUT;
4105
4106 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4107 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4108 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4109 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4110 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4111 ev->format = 32;
4112
4113 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4114 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4115 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4116 into that array in the event. */
4117 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4118 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4119 break;
4120
4121 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4122 {
4123 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4124 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4125 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4126
4127 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4128 nbytes);
4129 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4130 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4131 }
4132
4133 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4134 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4135 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4136 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4137 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4138 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4139
4140 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4141 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4142
4143 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4144 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4145 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4146 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4147 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4148 }
4149
4150
4151 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4152 in *IEVENT. */
4153
4154 static void
4155 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4156 XEvent *event;
4157 struct input_event *ievent;
4158 {
4159 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4160 Lisp_Object window;
4161 struct frame *f;
4162 struct window *w;
4163
4164 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4165 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4166
4167 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4168 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4169
4170 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4171 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4172 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4173 #ifdef USE_GTK
4174 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4175 #else
4176 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4177 #endif
4178 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4179 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4180 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4181 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4182 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4183 }
4184
4185
4186 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4187
4188 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4189
4190 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4191
4192
4193 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4194 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4195 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4196
4197 static void
4198 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4199 Widget widget;
4200 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4201 {
4202 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4203 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4204 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4205
4206 switch (cs->reason)
4207 {
4208 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4209 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4210 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4211 break;
4212
4213 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4214 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4215 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4216 break;
4217
4218 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4219 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4220 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4221 break;
4222
4223 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4224 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4225 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4226 break;
4227
4228 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4229 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4230 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4231 break;
4232
4233 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4234 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4235 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4236 break;
4237
4238 case XmCR_DRAG:
4239 {
4240 int slider_size;
4241
4242 /* Get the slider size. */
4243 BLOCK_INPUT;
4244 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4245 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4246
4247 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4248 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4249 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4250 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4251 }
4252 break;
4253
4254 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4255 break;
4256 };
4257
4258 if (part >= 0)
4259 {
4260 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4261 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4262 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4263 }
4264 }
4265
4266
4267 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4268 #ifdef USE_GTK
4269 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4270 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4271
4272 static void
4273 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4274 GtkRange *widget;
4275 gpointer data;
4276 {
4277 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4278 gdouble previous;
4279 gdouble position;
4280 gdouble *p;
4281 int diff;
4282
4283 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4284 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4285
4286 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4287
4288 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4289 if (! p)
4290 {
4291 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4292 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4293 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4294 }
4295
4296 previous = *p;
4297 *p = position;
4298
4299 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4300
4301 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4302
4303 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4304 {
4305 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4306 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4307 }
4308 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4309 {
4310 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4311 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4312 }
4313 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4314 {
4315 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4316 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4317 }
4318 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4319 {
4320 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4321 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4322 }
4323 else
4324 {
4325 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4326 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4327 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4328 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4329 }
4330
4331 if (part >= 0)
4332 {
4333 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4334 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4335 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4336 }
4337 }
4338
4339 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4340
4341 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4342 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4343 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4344 the thumb is. */
4345
4346 static void
4347 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4348 Widget widget;
4349 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4350 {
4351 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4352 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4353 float shown;
4354 int whole, portion, height;
4355 int part;
4356
4357 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4358 BLOCK_INPUT;
4359 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4360 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4361
4362 whole = 10000000;
4363 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4364
4365 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4366 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4367 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4368 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4369 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4370 bottom). */
4371 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4372 else
4373 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4374
4375 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4376 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4377 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4378 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4379 }
4380
4381
4382 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4383 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4384 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4385 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4386 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4387 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4388 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4389
4390 static void
4391 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4392 Widget widget;
4393 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4394 {
4395 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4396 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4397 int position = (long) call_data;
4398 Dimension height;
4399 int part;
4400
4401 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4402 BLOCK_INPUT;
4403 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4404 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4405
4406 if (abs (position) >= height)
4407 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4408
4409 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4410 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4411 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4412 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4413 else
4414 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4415
4416 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4417 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4418 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4419 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4420 }
4421
4422 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4423 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4424
4425 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4426
4427 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4428 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4429
4430 #ifdef USE_GTK
4431 static void
4432 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4433 struct frame *f;
4434 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4435 {
4436 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4437
4438 BLOCK_INPUT;
4439 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4440 scroll_bar_name);
4441 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4442 }
4443
4444 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4445
4446 static void
4447 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4448 struct frame *f;
4449 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4450 {
4451 Window xwindow;
4452 Widget widget;
4453 Arg av[20];
4454 int ac = 0;
4455 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4456 unsigned long pixel;
4457
4458 BLOCK_INPUT;
4459
4460 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4461 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4462 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4463 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4464 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4465 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4466 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4467 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4468 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4469
4470 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4471 if (pixel != -1)
4472 {
4473 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4474 ++ac;
4475 }
4476
4477 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4478 if (pixel != -1)
4479 {
4480 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4481 ++ac;
4482 }
4483
4484 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4485 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4486
4487 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4488 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4489 (XtPointer) bar);
4490 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4491 (XtPointer) bar);
4492 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4493 (XtPointer) bar);
4494 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4495 (XtPointer) bar);
4496 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4497 (XtPointer) bar);
4498 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4499 (XtPointer) bar);
4500 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4501 (XtPointer) bar);
4502
4503 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4504 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4505
4506 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4507 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4508 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4509 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4510
4511 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4512
4513 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4514 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4515 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4516 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4517 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4518 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4519 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4520 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4521
4522 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4523 if (pixel != -1)
4524 {
4525 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4526 ++ac;
4527 }
4528
4529 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4530 if (pixel != -1)
4531 {
4532 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4533 ++ac;
4534 }
4535
4536 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4537
4538 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4539 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4540 {
4541 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4542 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4543 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4544 pixel = -1;
4545 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4546 }
4547 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4548 {
4549 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4550 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4551 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4552 pixel = -1;
4553 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4554 }
4555
4556 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4557 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4558 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4559 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4560 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4561 {
4562 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4563 ++ac;
4564 }
4565 else
4566 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4567 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4568 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4569 {
4570 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4571 the shadows. */
4572 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4573 ++ac;
4574
4575 /* Specify the colors. */
4576 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4577 if (pixel != -1)
4578 {
4579 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
4580 ++ac;
4581 }
4582 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4583 if (pixel != -1)
4584 {
4585 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
4586 ++ac;
4587 }
4588 }
4589
4590 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4591 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4592
4593 {
4594 char *initial = "";
4595 char *val = initial;
4596 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4597 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4598 if (val == initial)
4599 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4600 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4601 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
4602 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4603 }
4604 }
4605
4606 /* Define callbacks. */
4607 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4608 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4609 (XtPointer) bar);
4610
4611 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4612 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4613
4614 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4615
4616 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4617 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4618 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4619 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4620
4621 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4622 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4623 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4624 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4625
4626 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4627 }
4628 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4629
4630
4631 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4632 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4633
4634 #ifdef USE_GTK
4635 static void
4636 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4637 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4638 int portion, position, whole;
4639 {
4640 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4641 }
4642
4643 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4644 static void
4645 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4646 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4647 int portion, position, whole;
4648 {
4649 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4650 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4651 float top, shown;
4652
4653 BLOCK_INPUT;
4654
4655 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4656
4657 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4658 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4659 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4660 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4661 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4662 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4663 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4664 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4665 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4666 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4667 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4668 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4669 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4670 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4671 whole += portion;
4672
4673 if (whole <= 0)
4674 top = 0, shown = 1;
4675 else
4676 {
4677 top = (float) position / whole;
4678 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4679 }
4680
4681 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4682 {
4683 int size, value;
4684
4685 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4686 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4687 value. */
4688 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4689 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4690 size = max (size, 1);
4691
4692 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4693 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4694 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4695
4696 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4697 }
4698 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4699
4700 if (whole == 0)
4701 top = 0, shown = 1;
4702 else
4703 {
4704 top = (float) position / whole;
4705 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4706 }
4707
4708 {
4709 float old_top, old_shown;
4710 Dimension height;
4711 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4712 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4713 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4714 XtNheight, &height,
4715 NULL);
4716
4717 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4718 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4719 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4720 else
4721 top = old_top;
4722 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4723 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4724
4725 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4726 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4727 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4728 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4729 {
4730 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4731 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4732 else
4733 {
4734 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4735 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
4736 int scroll_mode = 0;
4737
4738 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
4739 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
4740 {
4741 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
4742 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
4743 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
4744 if (scroll_mode == 2)
4745 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
4746 }
4747 #endif
4748 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4749 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4750 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4751
4752 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4753
4754 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4755 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
4756 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
4757 #endif
4758 }
4759 }
4760 }
4761 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4762
4763 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4764 }
4765 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4766
4767 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4768
4769
4770 \f
4771 /************************************************************************
4772 Scroll bars, general
4773 ************************************************************************/
4774
4775 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4776 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4777 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4778 scroll bar. */
4779
4780 static struct scroll_bar *
4781 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4782 struct window *w;
4783 int top, left, width, height;
4784 {
4785 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4786 struct scroll_bar *bar
4787 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4788
4789 BLOCK_INPUT;
4790
4791 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4792 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4793 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4794 {
4795 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4796 unsigned long mask;
4797 Window window;
4798
4799 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4800 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4801 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4802
4803 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4804 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4805 | ExposureMask);
4806 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4807
4808 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4809
4810 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4811 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4812 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4813 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4814 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4815 left, top, width,
4816 window_box_height (w), False);
4817
4818 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4819 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4820 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4821 top,
4822 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4823 height,
4824 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4825 0,
4826 CopyFromParent,
4827 CopyFromParent,
4828 CopyFromParent,
4829 /* Attributes. */
4830 mask, &a);
4831 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4832 }
4833 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4834
4835 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4836 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4837 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4838 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4839 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4840 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4841 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4842 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4843
4844 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4845 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4846 bar->prev = Qnil;
4847 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4848 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4849 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4850
4851 /* Map the window/widget. */
4852 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4853 {
4854 #ifdef USE_GTK
4855 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4856 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4857 top,
4858 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4859 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4860 max (height, 1));
4861 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4862 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4863 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4864 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4865 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4866 top,
4867 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4868 max (height, 1), 0);
4869 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4870 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4871 }
4872 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4873 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4874 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4875
4876 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4877 return bar;
4878 }
4879
4880
4881 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4882
4883 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4884 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4885 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4886 events.)
4887
4888 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4889 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4890 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4891 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4892 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4893
4894 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4895
4896 static void
4897 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4898 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4899 int start, end;
4900 int rebuild;
4901 {
4902 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4903 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4904 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4905 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4906
4907 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4908 if (! rebuild
4909 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4910 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4911 return;
4912
4913 BLOCK_INPUT;
4914
4915 {
4916 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4917 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4918 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4919
4920 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4921 the distance between start and end. */
4922 {
4923 int length = end - start;
4924
4925 if (start < 0)
4926 start = 0;
4927 else if (start > top_range)
4928 start = top_range;
4929 end = start + length;
4930
4931 if (end < start)
4932 end = start;
4933 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4934 end = top_range;
4935 }
4936
4937 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4938 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4939 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4940
4941 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4942 if (end > top_range)
4943 end = top_range;
4944
4945 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4946 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4947 that many pixels tall. */
4948 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4949
4950 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4951 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4952 if (0 < start)
4953 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4954 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4955 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4956 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4957 inside_width, start,
4958 False);
4959
4960 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4961 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4962 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4963 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4964
4965 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4966 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4967 /* x, y, width, height */
4968 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4969 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4970 inside_width, end - start);
4971
4972 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4973 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4974 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4975 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4976
4977 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4978 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4979 if (end < inside_height)
4980 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4981 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4982 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4983 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4984 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4985 False);
4986
4987 }
4988
4989 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4990 }
4991
4992 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4993
4994 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4995 nil. */
4996
4997 static void
4998 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4999 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5000 {
5001 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5002 BLOCK_INPUT;
5003
5004 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5005 #ifdef USE_GTK
5006 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
5007 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5008 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5009 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5010 #else
5011 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
5012 #endif
5013
5014 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5015 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5016
5017 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5018 }
5019
5020
5021 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5022 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5023 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5024 create one. */
5025
5026 static void
5027 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
5028 struct window *w;
5029 int portion, whole, position;
5030 {
5031 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5032 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5033 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5034 int window_y, window_height;
5035
5036 /* Get window dimensions. */
5037 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5038 top = window_y;
5039 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5040 height = window_height;
5041
5042 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5043 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5044
5045 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5046 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5047 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5048 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5049 else
5050 sb_width = width;
5051
5052 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5053 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5054 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5055 sb_left = (left +
5056 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5057 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
5058 : 0));
5059 else
5060 sb_left = (left +
5061 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5062 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
5063 : width - sb_width));
5064 #else
5065 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5066 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5067 else
5068 sb_left = left;
5069 #endif
5070
5071 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5072 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5073 {
5074 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5075 {
5076 BLOCK_INPUT;
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 left, top, width, height, False);
5079 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5080 }
5081
5082 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5083 }
5084 else
5085 {
5086 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5087 unsigned int mask = 0;
5088
5089 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5090
5091 BLOCK_INPUT;
5092
5093 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5094 mask |= CWX;
5095 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5096 mask |= CWY;
5097 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5098 mask |= CWWidth;
5099 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5100 mask |= CWHeight;
5101
5102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5103
5104 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5105 if (mask)
5106 {
5107 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5108 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5109 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5110 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5111 left, top, width, height, False);
5112 #ifdef USE_GTK
5113 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5114 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5115 top,
5116 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5117 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5118 max (height, 1));
5119 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5120 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5121 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5122 top,
5123 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5124 max (height, 1), 0);
5125 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5126 }
5127 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5128
5129 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5130 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5131 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5132 {
5133 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5134 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5135 height, False);
5136 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5137 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5138 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5139 height, False);
5140 }
5141
5142 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5143 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5144 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5145 example. */
5146 {
5147 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5148 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5149 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5150 {
5151 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5152 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5153 left + area_width - rest, top,
5154 rest, height, False);
5155 else
5156 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5157 left, top, rest, height, False);
5158 }
5159 }
5160
5161 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5162 if (mask)
5163 {
5164 XWindowChanges wc;
5165
5166 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5167 wc.y = top;
5168 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5169 wc.height = height;
5170 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5171 mask, &wc);
5172 }
5173
5174 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5175
5176 /* Remember new settings. */
5177 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5178 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5179 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5180 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5181
5182 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5183 }
5184
5185 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5186 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5187 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5188 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5189 dragged. */
5190 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5191 {
5192 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5193
5194 if (whole == 0)
5195 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5196 else
5197 {
5198 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5199 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5200 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5201 }
5202 }
5203 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5204
5205 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5206 }
5207
5208
5209 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5210 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5211 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5212 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5213 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5214 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5215 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5216
5217 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5218 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5219 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5220
5221 static void
5222 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5223 FRAME_PTR frame;
5224 {
5225 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5226 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5227 {
5228 Lisp_Object bar;
5229 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5230 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5231 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5232 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5233 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5234 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5235 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5236 }
5237 }
5238
5239
5240 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5241 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5242
5243 static void
5244 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5245 struct window *window;
5246 {
5247 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5248 struct frame *f;
5249
5250 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5251 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5252 abort ();
5253
5254 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5255
5256 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5257 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5258 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5259 {
5260 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5261 the lists. */
5262 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5263 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5264 return;
5265 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5266 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5267 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5268 else
5269 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5270 one or the other! */
5271 abort ();
5272 }
5273 else
5274 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5275
5276 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5277 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5278
5279 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5280 bar->prev = Qnil;
5281 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5282 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5283 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5284 }
5285
5286 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5287 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5288
5289 static void
5290 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5291 FRAME_PTR f;
5292 {
5293 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5294
5295 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5296
5297 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5298 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5299 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5300
5301 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5302 {
5303 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5304
5305 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5306
5307 next = b->next;
5308 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5309 }
5310
5311 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5312 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5313 }
5314
5315
5316 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5317 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5318 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5319
5320 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5321 mark bits. */
5322
5323 static void
5324 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5325 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5326 XEvent *event;
5327 {
5328 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5329 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5330 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5331 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5332
5333 BLOCK_INPUT;
5334
5335 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5336
5337 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5338 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5339
5340 /* x, y, width, height */
5341 0, 0,
5342 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5343 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5344
5345 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5346
5347 }
5348 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5349
5350 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5351 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5352
5353 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5354 mark bits. */
5355
5356
5357 static void
5358 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5359 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5360 XEvent *event;
5361 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5362 {
5363 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5364 abort ();
5365
5366 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5367 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5368 emacs_event->modifiers
5369 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5370 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5371 event->xbutton.state)
5372 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5373 ? up_modifier
5374 : down_modifier));
5375 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5376 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5377 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5378 {
5379 #if 0
5380 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5381 int internal_height
5382 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5383 #endif
5384 int top_range
5385 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5386 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5387
5388 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5389 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5390
5391 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5392 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5393 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5394 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5395 else
5396 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5397
5398 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5399 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5400 whether or not we're dragging. */
5401 #if 0
5402 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5403 holding it. */
5404 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5405 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5406 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5407 #endif
5408
5409 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5410 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5411 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5412 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5413 {
5414 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5415 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5416
5417 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5418 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5419 }
5420 #endif
5421
5422 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5423 #if 0
5424 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5425 the handle. */
5426 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5427 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5428 else
5429 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5430 #else
5431 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5432 #endif
5433
5434 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5435 }
5436 }
5437
5438 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5439
5440 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5441
5442 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5443 mark bits. */
5444
5445 static void
5446 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5447 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5448 XEvent *event;
5449 {
5450 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5451
5452 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5453
5454 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5455 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5456
5457 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5458 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5459 {
5460 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5461 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5462
5463 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5464 {
5465 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5466
5467 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5468 }
5469 }
5470 }
5471
5472 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5473
5474 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5475 on the scroll bar. */
5476
5477 static void
5478 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5479 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5480 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5481 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5482 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5483 unsigned long *time;
5484 {
5485 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5486 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5487 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5488 int win_x, win_y;
5489 Window dummy_window;
5490 int dummy_coord;
5491 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5492
5493 BLOCK_INPUT;
5494
5495 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5496 report that. */
5497 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5498
5499 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5500 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5501 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5502
5503 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5504 &win_x, &win_y,
5505
5506 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5507 &dummy_mask))
5508 ;
5509 else
5510 {
5511 #if 0
5512 int inside_height
5513 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5514 #endif
5515 int top_range
5516 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5517
5518 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5519
5520 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5521 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5522
5523 if (win_y < 0)
5524 win_y = 0;
5525 if (win_y > top_range)
5526 win_y = top_range;
5527
5528 *fp = f;
5529 *bar_window = bar->window;
5530
5531 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5532 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5533 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5534 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5535 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5536 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5537 else
5538 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5539
5540 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5541 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5542
5543 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5544 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5545 }
5546
5547 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5548
5549 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5550 }
5551
5552
5553 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5554 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5555 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5556 redraw them. */
5557
5558 void
5559 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5560 FRAME_PTR f;
5561 {
5562 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5563 Lisp_Object bar;
5564
5565 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5566 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5567 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5568 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5569 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5570 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5571 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5572 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5573 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5574 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5575 }
5576
5577 \f
5578 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5579
5580 #if 0
5581 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5582 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5583 sometimes don't work. */
5584
5585 static Time enter_timestamp;
5586 #endif
5587
5588 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5589 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5590 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5591 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5592
5593 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5594 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5595
5596 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5597
5598 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5599 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5600
5601 static int temp_index;
5602 static short temp_buffer[100];
5603
5604 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5605 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5606 temp_index = 0; \
5607 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5608
5609 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5610 on a particular display. */
5611
5612 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5613
5614 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5615 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5616 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5617 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5618
5619 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5620
5621 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5622 do \
5623 { \
5624 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5625 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5626 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5627 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5628 inev.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5629 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f); \
5630 } \
5631 while (0)
5632
5633 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5634 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5635
5636
5637 enum
5638 {
5639 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5640 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5641 X_EVENT_DROP
5642 };
5643
5644 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5645 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5646 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5647
5648 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5649 this event further.
5650 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5651
5652 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5653 static int
5654 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5655 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5656 XEvent *event;
5657 {
5658 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5659 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5660 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5661 was created. */
5662
5663 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5664 event->xclient.window);
5665
5666 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5667 }
5668 #endif
5669
5670 #ifdef USE_GTK
5671 static int current_count;
5672 static int current_finish;
5673 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5674
5675 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5676 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5677 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5678 static GdkFilterReturn
5679 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5680 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5681 GdkEvent *ev;
5682 gpointer data;
5683 {
5684 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5685
5686 if (current_count >= 0)
5687 {
5688 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5689
5690 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5691
5692 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5693 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5694 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5695 so we do it here. */
5696 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5697 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5698 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5699 #endif
5700
5701 if (! dpyinfo)
5702 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5703 else
5704 {
5705 current_count +=
5706 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5707 current_hold_quit);
5708 }
5709 }
5710 else
5711 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5712
5713 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5714 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5715
5716 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5717 }
5718 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5719
5720
5721 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5722
5723 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5724 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5725 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5726
5727 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5728
5729 static int
5730 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5731 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5732 XEvent *eventp;
5733 int *finish;
5734 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5735 {
5736 struct input_event inev;
5737 int count = 0;
5738 int do_help = 0;
5739 int nbytes = 0;
5740 struct frame *f;
5741 struct coding_system coding;
5742 XEvent event = *eventp;
5743
5744 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5745
5746 EVENT_INIT (inev);
5747 inev.kind = NO_EVENT;
5748 inev.arg = Qnil;
5749
5750 switch (event.type)
5751 {
5752 case ClientMessage:
5753 {
5754 if (event.xclient.message_type
5755 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5756 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5757 {
5758 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5759 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5760 {
5761 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5762 could be the shell widget window
5763 if the frame has no title bar. */
5764 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5765 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5766 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5767 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5768 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5769 #endif
5770 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5771 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5772 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5773 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5774 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5775 needed.
5776
5777 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5778 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5779 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5780 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5781 Emacs. */
5782
5783 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5784 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5785 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5786 if (f)
5787 {
5788 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5789 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5790 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5791 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5792 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5793 /* The ICCCM says this is
5794 the only valid choice. */
5795 RevertToParent,
5796 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5797 /* This is needed to detect the error
5798 if there is an error. */
5799 XSync (d, False);
5800 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5801 }
5802 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5803 #endif /* 0 */
5804 goto done;
5805 }
5806
5807 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5808 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5809 {
5810 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5811 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5812 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5813 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5814 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5815 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5816 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5817 session manager and one for this. */
5818 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5819 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5820 #endif
5821 {
5822 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5823 event.xclient.window);
5824 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5825 for a single Emacs process. */
5826 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5827 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5828 event.xclient.window,
5829 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5830 else if (f)
5831 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5832 event.xclient.window,
5833 0, 0);
5834 }
5835 goto done;
5836 }
5837
5838 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5839 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5840 {
5841 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5842 event.xclient.window);
5843 if (!f)
5844 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5845
5846 inev.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5847 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
5848 goto done;
5849 }
5850
5851 goto done;
5852 }
5853
5854 if (event.xclient.message_type
5855 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5856 {
5857 goto done;
5858 }
5859
5860 if (event.xclient.message_type
5861 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5862 {
5863 int new_x, new_y;
5864 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5865
5866 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5867 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5868
5869 if (f)
5870 {
5871 f->left_pos = new_x;
5872 f->top_pos = new_y;
5873 }
5874 goto done;
5875 }
5876
5877 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5878 if (event.xclient.message_type
5879 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5880 {
5881 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5882 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5883 &event, NULL);
5884 goto done;
5885 }
5886 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5887
5888 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5889 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5890 || (event.xclient.message_type
5891 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5892 {
5893 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5894 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5895 currently never do because we are interested in
5896 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5897 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5898 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5899 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5900 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5901 goto done;
5902 }
5903
5904 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5905 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5906 we construct an input_event. */
5907 if (event.xclient.message_type
5908 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5909 {
5910 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev);
5911 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5912 goto done;
5913 }
5914 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5915
5916 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5917
5918 if (!f)
5919 goto OTHER;
5920
5921 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev))
5922 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5923 }
5924 break;
5925
5926 case SelectionNotify:
5927 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5928 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5929 goto OTHER;
5930 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5931 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5932 break;
5933
5934 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5935 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5936 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5937 goto OTHER;
5938 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5939 {
5940 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5941
5942 inev.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5943 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
5944 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
5945 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
5946 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5947 }
5948 break;
5949
5950 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5951 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5952 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5953 goto OTHER;
5954 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5955 {
5956 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5957 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5958
5959 inev.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5960 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
5961 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev) = eventp->requestor;
5962 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
5963 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev) = eventp->target;
5964 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev) = eventp->property;
5965 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
5966 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5967 }
5968 break;
5969
5970 case PropertyNotify:
5971 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5972 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5973 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5974 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5975 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5976 goto OTHER;
5977 #endif
5978 #endif
5979 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5980 goto OTHER;
5981
5982 case ReparentNotify:
5983 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5984 if (f)
5985 {
5986 int x, y;
5987 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5988 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5989 f->left_pos = x;
5990 f->top_pos = y;
5991
5992 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5993 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5994 }
5995 goto OTHER;
5996
5997 case Expose:
5998 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5999 if (f)
6000 {
6001 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6002
6003 #ifdef USE_GTK
6004 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6005 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6006 event.xexpose.window,
6007 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6008 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6009 FALSE);
6010 #endif
6011 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6012 {
6013 f->async_visible = 1;
6014 f->async_iconified = 0;
6015 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6016 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6017 }
6018 else
6019 expose_frame (f,
6020 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6021 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6022 }
6023 else
6024 {
6025 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6026 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6027 #endif
6028 #if defined USE_LUCID
6029 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6030 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6031 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6032 {
6033 Widget widget
6034 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6035 if (widget)
6036 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6037 }
6038 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6039
6040 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6041 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6042 goto OTHER;
6043 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6044 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6045 event.xexpose.window);
6046
6047 if (bar)
6048 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6049 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6050 else
6051 goto OTHER;
6052 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6053 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6054 }
6055 break;
6056
6057 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6058 source area was obscured or not
6059 available. */
6060 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6061 if (f)
6062 {
6063 expose_frame (f,
6064 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6065 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6066 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6067 }
6068 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6069 else
6070 goto OTHER;
6071 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6072 break;
6073
6074 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6075 source area was completely
6076 available. */
6077 break;
6078
6079 case UnmapNotify:
6080 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6081 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6082 {
6083 tip_window = 0;
6084 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6085 }
6086
6087 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6088 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6089 the frame was deleted. */
6090 {
6091 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6092 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6093 display that won't ever be seen. */
6094 f->async_visible = 0;
6095 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6096 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6097 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6098 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6099 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6100 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6101 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6102 {
6103 f->async_iconified = 1;
6104
6105 inev.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6106 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6107 }
6108 }
6109 goto OTHER;
6110
6111 case MapNotify:
6112 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6113 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6114 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6115 goto OTHER;
6116
6117 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6118 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6119 frame is visible. */
6120 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6121 if (f)
6122 {
6123 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6124 the frame's display structures.
6125 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6126 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6127 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6128 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6129 if (! f->async_iconified)
6130 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6131
6132 f->async_visible = 1;
6133 f->async_iconified = 0;
6134 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6135
6136 if (f->iconified)
6137 {
6138 inev.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6139 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6140 }
6141 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6142 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6143 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6144 to update the frame titles
6145 in case this is the second frame. */
6146 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6147 }
6148 goto OTHER;
6149
6150 case KeyPress:
6151
6152 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6153
6154 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6155 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6156 if (popup_activated ())
6157 goto OTHER;
6158 #endif
6159
6160 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6161
6162 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6163 {
6164 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6165 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6166 }
6167
6168 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6169 if (f == 0)
6170 {
6171 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6172 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6173 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6174 event.xkey.window);
6175 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6176 {
6177 widget = XtParent (widget);
6178 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6179 }
6180 }
6181 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6182
6183 if (f != 0)
6184 {
6185 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6186 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6187 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6188 his Emacs hang.
6189
6190 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6191 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6192 status_return even if the input is too long to
6193 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6194 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6195 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6196 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6197 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6198 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6199 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6200 int modifiers;
6201 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6202 Lisp_Object c;
6203
6204 #ifdef USE_GTK
6205 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6206 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6207 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6208 (see above). */
6209 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6210 #endif
6211
6212 event.xkey.state
6213 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6214 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6215 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6216
6217 /* This will have to go some day... */
6218
6219 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6220 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6221 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6222 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6223 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6224 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6225 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6226
6227 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6228 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6229 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6230 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6231 not it is combined with Meta. */
6232 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6233 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6234
6235 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6236 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6237 {
6238 Status status_return;
6239
6240 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6241 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6242 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6243 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6244 &status_return);
6245 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6246 {
6247 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6248 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6249 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6250 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6251 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6252 &status_return);
6253 }
6254 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6255 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6256 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6257 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6258 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6259 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6260 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6261 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6262 &status_return);
6263 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6264 {
6265 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6266 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6267 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6268 &event.xkey,
6269 copy_bufptr,
6270 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6271 &status_return);
6272 }
6273 }
6274 #endif
6275
6276 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6277 break;
6278 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6279 {
6280 keysym = NoSymbol;
6281 modifiers = 0;
6282 }
6283 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6284 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6285 abort ();
6286 }
6287 else
6288 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6289 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6290 &compose_status);
6291 #else
6292 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6293 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6294 &compose_status);
6295 #endif
6296
6297 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6298 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6299 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6300 break;
6301
6302 orig_keysym = keysym;
6303
6304 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6305 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6306 inev.modifiers
6307 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6308 inev.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6309
6310 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6311 translations to characters. */
6312 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6313 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6314 {
6315 inev.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6316 inev.code = keysym;
6317 goto done_keysym;
6318 }
6319
6320 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6321 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6322 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6323 Vx_keysym_table,
6324 Qnil))))
6325 {
6326 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6327 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6328 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6329 inev.code = XFASTINT (c);
6330 goto done_keysym;
6331 }
6332
6333 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6334 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6335 || keysym == XK_Delete
6336 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6337 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6338 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6339 #endif
6340 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6341 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6342 #ifdef HPUX
6343 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6344 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6345 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6346 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6347 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6348 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6349 #endif
6350 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6351 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6352 #endif
6353 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6354 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6355 #endif
6356 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6357 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6358 #endif
6359 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6360 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6361 #endif
6362 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6363 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6364 #endif
6365 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6366 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6367 #endif
6368 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6369 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6370 #endif
6371 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6372 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6373 #endif
6374 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6375 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6376 #endif
6377 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6378 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6379 #endif
6380 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6381 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6382 #endif
6383 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6384 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6385 #endif
6386 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6387 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6388 #endif
6389 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6390 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6391 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6392 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6393 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6394 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6395 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6396 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6397 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6398 #endif
6399 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6400 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6401 #endif
6402 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6403 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6404 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6405 don't have real modifiers but
6406 should be treated similarly to
6407 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6408 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6409 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6410 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6411 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6412 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6413 #endif
6414 ))
6415 {
6416 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6417 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6418 key. */
6419 inev.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6420 inev.code = keysym;
6421 goto done_keysym;
6422 }
6423
6424 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6425 register int i;
6426 register int c;
6427 int nchars, len;
6428
6429 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6430 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6431 we used just above and the locale. */
6432 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6433 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6434 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6435 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6436 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6437 gives us composition information. */
6438 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6439
6440 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6441 {
6442 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6443 }
6444
6445 {
6446 /* Decode the input data. */
6447 int require;
6448 unsigned char *p;
6449
6450 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6451 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6452 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6453 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6454 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6455 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6456 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6457 nbytes = coding.produced;
6458 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6459 copy_bufptr = p;
6460 }
6461
6462 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6463 character events. */
6464 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6465 {
6466 if (nchars == nbytes)
6467 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6468 else
6469 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6470 nbytes - i, len);
6471 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6472 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6473 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6474 inev.code = c;
6475 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6476 }
6477
6478 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6479 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6480 count += nbytes;
6481
6482 inev.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6483
6484 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6485 break;
6486 }
6487 }
6488 done_keysym:
6489 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6490 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6491 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6492 client. */
6493 break;
6494 #else
6495 goto OTHER;
6496 #endif
6497
6498 case KeyRelease:
6499 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6500 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6501 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6502 client. */
6503 break;
6504 #else
6505 goto OTHER;
6506 #endif
6507
6508 case EnterNotify:
6509 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6510
6511 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6512
6513 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6514 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6515
6516 #if 0
6517 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6518 {
6519 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6520 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6521 || !(f->auto_lower)
6522 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6523 {
6524 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6525 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6526 }
6527 }
6528 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6529 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6530 #endif
6531
6532 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6533 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6534 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6535 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6536 goto OTHER;
6537
6538 case FocusIn:
6539 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6540 goto OTHER;
6541
6542 case LeaveNotify:
6543 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6544
6545 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6546 if (f)
6547 {
6548 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6549 {
6550 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6551 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6552 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6553 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6554 }
6555
6556 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6557 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6558 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6559 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6560 if (any_help_event_p)
6561 do_help = -1;
6562 }
6563 goto OTHER;
6564
6565 case FocusOut:
6566 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6567 goto OTHER;
6568
6569 case MotionNotify:
6570 {
6571 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6572 help_echo_string = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
6573 help_echo_pos = -1;
6574
6575 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6576 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6577 f = last_mouse_frame;
6578 else
6579 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6580
6581 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6582 {
6583 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6584 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6585 }
6586
6587 if (f)
6588 {
6589
6590 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6591 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6592 {
6593 Lisp_Object window;
6594
6595 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6596 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6597 0, 0, 0, 0);
6598
6599 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6600 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6601 will be selected iff it is active. */
6602 if (WINDOWP (window)
6603 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6604 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6605 {
6606 inev.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6607 inev.frame_or_window = window;
6608 }
6609
6610 last_window=window;
6611 }
6612 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6613 }
6614 else
6615 {
6616 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6617 struct scroll_bar *bar
6618 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6619 event.xmotion.window);
6620
6621 if (bar)
6622 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6623 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6624
6625 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6626 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6627 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6628 }
6629
6630 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6631 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6632 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6633 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6634 do_help = 1;
6635 goto OTHER;
6636 }
6637
6638 case ConfigureNotify:
6639 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6640 if (f)
6641 {
6642 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6643 #ifdef USE_GTK
6644 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6645 event.xconfigure.height);
6646 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6647 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6648 do this one, the right one will come later.
6649 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6650 need to reset it below. */
6651 int dont_resize
6652 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6653 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6654 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6655 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6656
6657 if (dont_resize)
6658 goto OTHER;
6659
6660 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6661 is called by the code that handles resizing
6662 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6663
6664 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6665 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6666 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6667 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6668 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6669 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6670 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6671 {
6672 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6673 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6674 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6675 }
6676 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6677 #endif
6678
6679 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6680 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6681
6682 #ifdef USE_GTK
6683 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6684 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6685 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6686 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6687 #endif
6688 {
6689 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6690 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6691 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6692
6693 x_check_expected_move (f);
6694 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6695 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6696 }
6697
6698 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6699 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6700 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6701 #endif
6702
6703 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6704 {
6705 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6706 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6707 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6708 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6709 }
6710 }
6711 goto OTHER;
6712
6713 case ButtonRelease:
6714 case ButtonPress:
6715 {
6716 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6717 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6718 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6719
6720 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6721
6722 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6723 && last_mouse_frame
6724 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6725 f = last_mouse_frame;
6726 else
6727 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6728
6729 if (f)
6730 {
6731 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6732 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6733 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6734 {
6735 Lisp_Object window;
6736 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6737 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6738
6739 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6740 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6741 {
6742 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6743 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6744 else
6745 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6746 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6747 event.xbutton.state));
6748 tool_bar_p = 1;
6749 }
6750 }
6751
6752 if (!tool_bar_p)
6753 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6754 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6755 {
6756 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6757 if (! popup_activated ())
6758 #endif
6759 {
6760 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6761 {
6762 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6763 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6764 {
6765 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6766 construct_mouse_click (&inev, &event, f);
6767 }
6768 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6769 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6770 }
6771 else
6772 construct_mouse_click (&inev, &event, f);
6773 }
6774 }
6775 }
6776 else
6777 {
6778 struct scroll_bar *bar
6779 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6780 event.xbutton.window);
6781
6782 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6783 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6784 scroll bars. */
6785 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6786 {
6787 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6788 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6789 }
6790 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6791 if (bar)
6792 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6793 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6794 }
6795
6796 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6797 {
6798 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6799 last_mouse_frame = f;
6800 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
6801 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
6802 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
6803 the ButtonPress. */
6804 if (f != 0)
6805 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6806
6807 if (!tool_bar_p)
6808 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6809 }
6810 else
6811 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6812
6813 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6814 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6815 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6816 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6817 Instead, save it away
6818 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6819 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6820 if (
6821 #ifdef USE_GTK
6822 ! popup_activated ()
6823 &&
6824 #endif
6825 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6826 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6827 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6828 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6829 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6830 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6831 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6832 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6833 {
6834 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6835 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6836 #ifdef USE_GTK
6837 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6838 #endif
6839 }
6840 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6841 {
6842 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6843 goto OTHER;
6844 }
6845
6846 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6847 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6848 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6849 {
6850 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6851 {
6852 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6853 if (f->output_data.x)
6854 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6855 }
6856 else
6857 goto OTHER;
6858 }
6859 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6860 else
6861 goto OTHER;
6862 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6863 }
6864 break;
6865
6866 case CirculateNotify:
6867 goto OTHER;
6868
6869 case CirculateRequest:
6870 goto OTHER;
6871
6872 case VisibilityNotify:
6873 goto OTHER;
6874
6875 case MappingNotify:
6876 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6877 local cache. */
6878 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6879 {
6880 case MappingModifier:
6881 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6882 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6883 case MappingKeyboard:
6884 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6885 }
6886 goto OTHER;
6887
6888 default:
6889 OTHER:
6890 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6891 BLOCK_INPUT;
6892 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6893 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6894 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6895 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6896 break;
6897 }
6898
6899 done:
6900 if (inev.kind != NO_EVENT)
6901 {
6902 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6903 count++;
6904 }
6905
6906 if (do_help
6907 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6908 {
6909 Lisp_Object frame;
6910
6911 if (f)
6912 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6913 else
6914 frame = Qnil;
6915
6916 if (do_help > 0)
6917 {
6918 any_help_event_p = 1;
6919 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6920 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6921 }
6922 else
6923 {
6924 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6925 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6926 }
6927 count++;
6928 }
6929
6930 *eventp = event;
6931 return count;
6932 }
6933
6934
6935 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6936 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6937 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6938
6939 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6940 int
6941 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6942 XEvent *event;
6943 Display *display;
6944 {
6945 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6946 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6947
6948 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6949
6950 if (dpyinfo)
6951 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6952
6953 return finish;
6954 }
6955
6956
6957 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6958 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6959 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6960
6961 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6962 thus pretending to be `read'.
6963
6964 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6965
6966 static int
6967 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6968 register int sd;
6969 int expected;
6970 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6971 {
6972 int count = 0;
6973 XEvent event;
6974 int event_found = 0;
6975 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6976
6977 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6978 {
6979 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6980 return -1;
6981 }
6982
6983 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6984 BLOCK_INPUT;
6985
6986 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6987 input_signal_count++;
6988
6989 ++handling_signal;
6990
6991 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6992 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6993 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6994 {
6995 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6996 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6997 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6998 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6999 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
7000 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7001 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
7002 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7003 #endif
7004
7005 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7006 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7007 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7008 for X connections. */
7009 #ifndef SIGIO
7010 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7011 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7012 {
7013 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7014 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7015 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7016 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7017 }
7018 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7019 #endif /* SIGIO */
7020 #endif
7021
7022 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7023 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7024 {
7025 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7026 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7027 }
7028
7029 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7030 {
7031 struct input_event inev;
7032 BLOCK_INPUT;
7033 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7034 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7035 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7036 {
7037 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7038 count++;
7039 }
7040 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7041 }
7042 #endif
7043
7044 #ifndef USE_GTK
7045 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7046 {
7047 int finish;
7048
7049 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7050
7051 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7052 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7053 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7054 break;
7055 #endif
7056 event_found = 1;
7057
7058 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7059
7060 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7061 goto out;
7062 }
7063 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7064 }
7065
7066 #ifdef USE_GTK
7067
7068 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7069 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7070 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7071 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7072
7073 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7074 from all displays. */
7075
7076 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7077 {
7078 current_count = count;
7079 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7080
7081 gtk_main_iteration ();
7082
7083 count = current_count;
7084 current_count = -1;
7085 current_hold_quit = 0;
7086
7087 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7088 break;
7089 }
7090 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7091
7092 out:;
7093
7094 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7095 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7096 if (! event_found)
7097 {
7098 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7099 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7100 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7101 x_noop_count++;
7102 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7103 {
7104 x_noop_count=0;
7105
7106 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7107 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7108
7109 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7110
7111 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7112 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7113 }
7114 }
7115
7116 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7117 raise it now. */
7118 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7119 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7120 {
7121 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7122 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7123 }
7124
7125 --handling_signal;
7126 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7127
7128 return count;
7129 }
7130
7131
7132
7133 \f
7134 /***********************************************************************
7135 Text Cursor
7136 ***********************************************************************/
7137
7138 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7139 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7140
7141 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7142 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7143 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7144
7145 static void
7146 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7147 struct window *w;
7148 struct glyph_row *row;
7149 int area;
7150 GC gc;
7151 {
7152 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7153 XRectangle clip_rect;
7154 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7155
7156 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7157
7158 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7159 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
7160 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7161 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7162 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7163
7164 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7165 }
7166
7167
7168 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7169
7170 static void
7171 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7172 struct window *w;
7173 struct glyph_row *row;
7174 {
7175 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7176 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7177 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7178 int x, y, wd, h;
7179 XGCValues xgcv;
7180 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7181 GC gc;
7182
7183 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7184 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7185 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7186 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7187 return;
7188
7189 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
7190 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
7191 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
7192 width instead. */
7193 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
7194 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
7195 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
7196 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
7197 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
7198
7199 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
7200 coordinates. */
7201 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7202 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y);
7203
7204 /* Compute the proper height and ascent of the rectangle, based
7205 on the actual glyph. Using the full height of the row looks
7206 bad when there are tall images on that row. */
7207 h = max (min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), row->height),
7208 cursor_glyph->ascent + cursor_glyph->descent);
7209 if (h < row->height)
7210 y += row->ascent /* - w->phys_cursor_ascent */ + cursor_glyph->descent - h;
7211 h--;
7212
7213 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7214 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7215 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7216 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7217 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7218 else
7219 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7220 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7221 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7222
7223 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7224 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7225 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7226 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7227 }
7228
7229
7230 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7231
7232 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7233 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7234 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7235 --gerd. */
7236
7237 static void
7238 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7239 struct window *w;
7240 struct glyph_row *row;
7241 int width;
7242 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7243 {
7244 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7245 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7246
7247 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7248 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7249 and mini-buffer. */
7250 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7251 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7252 return;
7253
7254 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7255 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7256 the bar might not be in the window. */
7257 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7258 {
7259 struct glyph_row *row;
7260 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7261 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7262 }
7263 else
7264 {
7265 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7266 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7267 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7268 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7269 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7270 XGCValues xgcv;
7271
7272 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7273 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7274 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7275 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7276 that the glyph is legible. */
7277 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7278 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7279 else
7280 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7281 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7282
7283 if (gc)
7284 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7285 else
7286 {
7287 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7288 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7289 }
7290
7291 if (width < 0)
7292 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7293 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7294
7295 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7296 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7297
7298 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7299 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7300 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7301 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7302 width, row->height);
7303 else
7304 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7305 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7306 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7307 row->height - width),
7308 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7309 width);
7310
7311 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7312 }
7313 }
7314
7315
7316 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7317
7318 static void
7319 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7320 struct frame *f;
7321 Cursor cursor;
7322 {
7323 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7324 }
7325
7326
7327 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7328
7329 static void
7330 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7331 struct frame *f;
7332 int x, y, width, height;
7333 {
7334 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7335 x, y, width, height, False);
7336 }
7337
7338
7339 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7340
7341 static void
7342 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7343 struct window *w;
7344 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7345 int x, y;
7346 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7347 int on_p, active_p;
7348 {
7349 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7350
7351 if (on_p)
7352 {
7353 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7354 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7355
7356 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7357 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7358 {
7359 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7360 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7361 }
7362 else
7363 switch (cursor_type)
7364 {
7365 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7366 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7367 break;
7368
7369 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7370 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7371 break;
7372
7373 case BAR_CURSOR:
7374 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7375 break;
7376
7377 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7378 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7379 break;
7380
7381 case NO_CURSOR:
7382 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7383 break;
7384
7385 default:
7386 abort ();
7387 }
7388
7389 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7390 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7391 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7392 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7393 #endif
7394 }
7395
7396 #ifndef XFlush
7397 if (updating_frame != f)
7398 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7399 #endif
7400 }
7401
7402 \f
7403 /* Icons. */
7404
7405 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7406
7407 int
7408 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7409 struct frame *f;
7410 Lisp_Object file;
7411 {
7412 int bitmap_id;
7413
7414 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7415 return 1;
7416
7417 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7418 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7419 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7420 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7421
7422 if (STRINGP (file))
7423 {
7424 #ifdef USE_GTK
7425 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7426 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7427 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7428 return 0;
7429 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7430 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7431 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7432 }
7433 else
7434 {
7435 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7436 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7437 {
7438 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
7439 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
7440 gnu_width, gnu_height);
7441 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7442 }
7443
7444 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7445 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7446 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7447 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7448 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7449
7450 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7451 }
7452
7453 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7454 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7455
7456 return 0;
7457 }
7458
7459
7460 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7461 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7462
7463 int
7464 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7465 struct frame *f;
7466 char *icon_name;
7467 {
7468 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7469 return 1;
7470
7471 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7472 {
7473 XTextProperty text;
7474 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7475 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7476 text.format = 8;
7477 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7478 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7479 }
7480 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7481 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7482 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7483
7484 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7485 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7486 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7487 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7488
7489 return 0;
7490 }
7491 \f
7492 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7493
7494 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7495 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7496
7497 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7498
7499 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7500 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7501 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7502
7503 static void
7504 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7505 Display *display;
7506 XErrorEvent *error;
7507 {
7508 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7509 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7510 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7511 }
7512
7513 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7514 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7515 operating on.
7516
7517 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7518 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7519 stored in x_error_message_string.
7520
7521 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7522 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7523
7524 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7525
7526 void x_check_errors ();
7527 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7528
7529 int
7530 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7531 Display *dpy;
7532 {
7533 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7534
7535 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7536 XSync (dpy, False);
7537
7538 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7539 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7540 x_error_message_string));
7541
7542 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7543 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7544
7545 return count;
7546 }
7547
7548 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7549
7550 static Lisp_Object
7551 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7552 Lisp_Object old_val;
7553 {
7554 Lisp_Object first = XCAR (old_val);
7555 Display *dpy = XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer;
7556
7557 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7558 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7559 if (x_display_info_for_display (dpy) != 0)
7560 {
7561 BLOCK_INPUT;
7562 XSync (dpy, False);
7563 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7564 }
7565
7566 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7567 return Qnil;
7568 }
7569
7570 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7571 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7572 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7573
7574 void
7575 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7576 Display *dpy;
7577 char *format;
7578 {
7579 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7580 XSync (dpy, False);
7581
7582 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7583 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7584 }
7585
7586 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7587 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7588
7589 int
7590 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7591 Display *dpy;
7592 {
7593 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7594 XSync (dpy, False);
7595
7596 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7597 }
7598
7599 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7600
7601 void
7602 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7603 Display *dpy;
7604 {
7605 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7606 }
7607
7608 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7609 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7610 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7611 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7612
7613 void
7614 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7615 Display *dpy;
7616 int count;
7617 {
7618 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7619 }
7620
7621 #if 0
7622 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7623 x_trace_wire ()
7624 {
7625 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7626 }
7627 #endif /* ! 0 */
7628
7629 \f
7630 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7631 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7632 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7633 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7634 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7635
7636 static SIGTYPE
7637 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7638 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7639 {
7640 #ifdef USG
7641 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7642 must reestablish each time */
7643 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7644 #endif /* USG */
7645 }
7646
7647 \f
7648 /************************************************************************
7649 Handling X errors
7650 ************************************************************************/
7651
7652 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7653
7654 static char *error_msg;
7655
7656 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7657 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7658 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7659
7660 static void
7661 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7662 {
7663 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7664 exit (70);
7665 }
7666
7667 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7668 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7669
7670 static SIGTYPE
7671 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7672 Display *dpy;
7673 char *error_message;
7674 {
7675 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7676 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7677 int count;
7678
7679 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7680 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7681 handling_signal = 0;
7682
7683 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7684 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7685 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7686 the original message here. */
7687 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7688
7689 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7690 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7691 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7692
7693 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7694 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7695 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7696
7697 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7698 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7699
7700 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7701 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7702 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7703
7704 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7705 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7706 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7707 if (dpyinfo)
7708 {
7709 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7710 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7711 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7712 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7713 }
7714 #endif
7715
7716 #ifdef USE_GTK
7717 if (dpyinfo)
7718 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7719 #endif
7720
7721 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7722 if (dpyinfo)
7723 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7724
7725 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7726 that are on the dead display. */
7727 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7728 {
7729 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7730 minibuf_frame
7731 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7732 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7733 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7734 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7735 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7736 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7737 }
7738
7739 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7740 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7741 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7742 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7743 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7744 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7745 {
7746 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7747 trying to find a replacement. */
7748 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7749 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7750 }
7751
7752 if (dpyinfo)
7753 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7754
7755 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7756
7757 if (x_display_list == 0)
7758 {
7759 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7760 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7761 exit (70);
7762 }
7763
7764 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7765 #ifdef SIGIO
7766 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7767 #endif
7768 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7769 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7770
7771 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7772 error ("%s", error_msg);
7773 }
7774
7775
7776 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7777 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7778 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7779
7780 static void
7781 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7782 Display *display;
7783 XErrorEvent *error;
7784 {
7785 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7786
7787 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7788 original error handler. */
7789
7790 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7791 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7792 buf, error->request_code);
7793 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7794 }
7795
7796
7797 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7798 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7799
7800 static int
7801 x_error_handler (display, error)
7802 Display *display;
7803 XErrorEvent *error;
7804 {
7805 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7806 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7807 else
7808 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7809 return 0;
7810 }
7811
7812 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7813 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7814 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7815
7816 static int
7817 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7818 Display *display;
7819 {
7820 char buf[256];
7821
7822 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7823 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7824 return 0;
7825 }
7826 \f
7827 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7828
7829 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7830 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7831 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7832 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7833
7834 Lisp_Object
7835 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7836 struct frame *f;
7837 register char *fontname;
7838 {
7839 struct font_info *fontp
7840 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7841
7842 if (!fontp)
7843 return Qnil;
7844
7845 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7846 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7847 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7848
7849 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7850 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7851 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7852
7853 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7854
7855 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7856 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7857 {
7858 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7859 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7860 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7861 }
7862 else
7863 {
7864 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7865 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7866 }
7867
7868 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7869 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7870 {
7871 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7872 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7873 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7874 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7875 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7876 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7877
7878 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7879 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7880 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7881 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7882 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7883 }
7884
7885 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7886 }
7887
7888 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7889 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7890 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7891 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7892
7893 Lisp_Object
7894 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7895 struct frame *f;
7896 char *fontsetname;
7897 {
7898 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7899 Lisp_Object result;
7900
7901 if (fontset < 0)
7902 return Qnil;
7903
7904 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7905 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7906 to do. */
7907 return fontset_name (fontset);
7908
7909 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7910
7911 if (!STRINGP (result))
7912 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7913 return Qnil;
7914
7915 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7916 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7917
7918 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7919 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7920 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7921 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7922 #endif
7923
7924 return build_string (fontsetname);
7925 }
7926
7927 \f
7928 /***********************************************************************
7929 X Input Methods
7930 ***********************************************************************/
7931
7932 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7933
7934 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7935
7936 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7937 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7938 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7939
7940 static void
7941 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7942 XIM xim;
7943 XPointer client_data;
7944 XPointer call_data;
7945 {
7946 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7947 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7948
7949 BLOCK_INPUT;
7950
7951 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7952 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7953 {
7954 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7955 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7956 {
7957 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7958 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7959 }
7960 }
7961
7962 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7963 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7964 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7965 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7966 }
7967
7968 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7969
7970 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7971 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7972 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7973 #endif
7974
7975 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7976 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7977
7978 static void
7979 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
7980 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7981 char *resource_name;
7982 {
7983 XIM xim;
7984
7985 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7986 if (use_xim)
7987 {
7988 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7989 EMACS_CLASS);
7990 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7991
7992 if (xim)
7993 {
7994 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7995 XIMCallback destroy;
7996 #endif
7997
7998 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7999 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8000
8001 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8002 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8003 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8004 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8005 #endif
8006 }
8007 }
8008
8009 else
8010 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8011 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8012 }
8013
8014
8015 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8016
8017 struct xim_inst_t
8018 {
8019 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8020 char *resource_name;
8021 };
8022
8023 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8024 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8025 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8026 when the callback was registered. */
8027
8028 static void
8029 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8030 Display *display;
8031 XPointer client_data;
8032 XPointer call_data;
8033 {
8034 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8035 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8036
8037 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8038 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8039 return;
8040
8041 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8042
8043 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8044 as they have no XIC. */
8045 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8046 {
8047 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8048
8049 BLOCK_INPUT;
8050 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8051 {
8052 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8053
8054 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8055 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8056 {
8057 create_frame_xic (f);
8058 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8059 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8060 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8061 {
8062 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8063 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8064 }
8065 }
8066 }
8067
8068 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8069 }
8070 }
8071
8072 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8073
8074
8075 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8076 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8077 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8078 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8079
8080 static void
8081 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8082 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8083 char *resource_name;
8084 {
8085 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8086 if (use_xim)
8087 {
8088 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8089 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8090 int len;
8091
8092 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8093 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8094 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8095 len = strlen (resource_name);
8096 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8097 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8098 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8099 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8100 xim_instantiate_callback,
8101 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8102 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8103 least, hence the configure test. */
8104 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8105 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8106 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8107 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8108 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8109
8110 }
8111 else
8112 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8113 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8114 }
8115
8116
8117 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8118
8119 static void
8120 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8121 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8122 {
8123 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8124 if (use_xim)
8125 {
8126 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8127 if (dpyinfo->display)
8128 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8129 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8130 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8131 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8132 if (dpyinfo->display)
8133 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8134 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8135 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8136 }
8137 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8138 }
8139
8140 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8141
8142
8143 \f
8144 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8145 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8146
8147 void
8148 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8149 struct frame *f;
8150 {
8151 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
8152 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8153
8154 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8155 is already for the top-left corner. */
8156 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8157 return;
8158
8159 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8160 position that fits on the screen. */
8161 if (flags & XNegative)
8162 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8163 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8164
8165 {
8166 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8167
8168 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8169 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8170 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8171
8172 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8173 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8174 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8175 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8176 is right, though.
8177
8178 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8179 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8180
8181 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8182 #endif
8183
8184 if (flags & YNegative)
8185 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8186 }
8187
8188 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8189 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8190 so the flags should correspond. */
8191 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8192 }
8193
8194 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8195 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8196 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8197 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8198 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8199
8200 void
8201 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8202 struct frame *f;
8203 register int xoff, yoff;
8204 int change_gravity;
8205 {
8206 int modified_top, modified_left;
8207
8208 if (change_gravity > 0)
8209 {
8210 f->top_pos = yoff;
8211 f->left_pos = xoff;
8212 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8213 if (xoff < 0)
8214 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8215 if (yoff < 0)
8216 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8217 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8218 }
8219 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8220
8221 BLOCK_INPUT;
8222 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8223
8224 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8225 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8226
8227 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8228 {
8229 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8230 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8231 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8232 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8233 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8234 }
8235
8236 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8237 modified_left, modified_top);
8238
8239 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8240 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8241 {
8242 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8243 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8244 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8245 }
8246
8247 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8248 }
8249
8250 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8251 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8252 static void
8253 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8254 struct frame *f;
8255 {
8256 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8257 {
8258 int width, height, ign;
8259
8260 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8261
8262 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8263
8264 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8265 when setting WM manager hints.
8266 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8267 x_check_expected_move. */
8268 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8269 {
8270 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8271 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8272 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8273
8274 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8275 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8276 }
8277 }
8278 }
8279
8280 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8281 the window.
8282 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8283 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8284 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8285 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8286 static void
8287 x_check_expected_move (f)
8288 struct frame *f;
8289 {
8290 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8291 {
8292 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8293 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8294
8295 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8296 {
8297 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8298 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8299 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8300
8301 f->left_pos = expect_left;
8302 f->top_pos = expect_top;
8303 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 0);
8304 }
8305 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8306 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8307
8308 /* Just do this once */
8309 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8310 }
8311 }
8312
8313
8314 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8315 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8316 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8317 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8318
8319 static void
8320 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8321 struct frame *f;
8322 int change_gravity;
8323 int cols, rows;
8324 {
8325 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8326
8327 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8328 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8329 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8330 ? 0
8331 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8332 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8333 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8334
8335 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8336
8337 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8338 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8339
8340 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8341 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8342
8343 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8344 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8345 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8346
8347 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8348 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8349 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8350 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8351
8352 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8353 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8354 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8355 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8356 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8357
8358 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8359 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8360 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8361 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8362 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8363
8364 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8365 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8366 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8367 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8368 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8369
8370 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8371 }
8372
8373
8374 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8375 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8376 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8377 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8378
8379 void
8380 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8381 struct frame *f;
8382 int change_gravity;
8383 int cols, rows;
8384 {
8385 BLOCK_INPUT;
8386
8387 #ifdef USE_GTK
8388 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8389 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8390 else
8391 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8392 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8393
8394 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8395 {
8396 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8397 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8398 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8399 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8400 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8401 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8402 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8403 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8404 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8405 }
8406 else
8407 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8408
8409 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8410
8411 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8412
8413 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8414
8415 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8416 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8417
8418 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8419 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8420 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8421 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8422 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8423
8424 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8425 }
8426 \f
8427 /* Mouse warping. */
8428
8429 void
8430 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8431 struct frame *f;
8432 int x, y;
8433 {
8434 int pix_x, pix_y;
8435
8436 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8437 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8438
8439 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8440 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8441
8442 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8443 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8444
8445 BLOCK_INPUT;
8446
8447 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8448 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8449 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8450 }
8451
8452 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8453
8454 void
8455 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8456 struct frame *f;
8457 int pix_x, pix_y;
8458 {
8459 BLOCK_INPUT;
8460
8461 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8462 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8463 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8464 }
8465 \f
8466 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8467
8468 void
8469 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8470 struct frame *f;
8471 {
8472 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8473 x_raise_frame (f);
8474 #endif
8475 #if 0
8476 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8477 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8478 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8479 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8480 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8481 #endif /* ! 0 */
8482 }
8483
8484 void
8485 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8486 struct frame *f;
8487 {
8488 #if 0
8489 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8490 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8491 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8492 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8493 #endif /* ! 0 */
8494 }
8495
8496 /* Raise frame F. */
8497
8498 void
8499 x_raise_frame (f)
8500 struct frame *f;
8501 {
8502 if (f->async_visible)
8503 {
8504 BLOCK_INPUT;
8505 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8506 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8507 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8508 }
8509 }
8510
8511 /* Lower frame F. */
8512
8513 void
8514 x_lower_frame (f)
8515 struct frame *f;
8516 {
8517 if (f->async_visible)
8518 {
8519 BLOCK_INPUT;
8520 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8521 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8522 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8523 }
8524 }
8525
8526 static void
8527 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8528 FRAME_PTR f;
8529 int raise_flag;
8530 {
8531 if (raise_flag)
8532 x_raise_frame (f);
8533 else
8534 x_lower_frame (f);
8535 }
8536 \f
8537 /* Change of visibility. */
8538
8539 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8540 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8541 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8542 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8543 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8544 finishes with it. */
8545
8546 void
8547 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8548 struct frame *f;
8549 {
8550 Lisp_Object type;
8551 int original_top, original_left;
8552 int retry_count = 2;
8553
8554 retry:
8555
8556 BLOCK_INPUT;
8557
8558 type = x_icon_type (f);
8559 if (!NILP (type))
8560 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8561
8562 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8563 {
8564 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8565 call x_set_offset a second time
8566 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8567 before the window gets really visible. */
8568 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8569 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8570 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8571
8572 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8573
8574 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8575 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8576 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8577 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8578 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8579 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8580 #ifdef USE_GTK
8581 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8582 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8583 #else
8584 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8585 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8586 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8587 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8588 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8589 to come back ok without this. */
8590 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8591 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8592 #endif
8593 }
8594
8595 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8596
8597 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8598 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8599 so that incoming events are handled. */
8600 {
8601 Lisp_Object frame;
8602 int count;
8603 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8604 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8605 will set it when they are handled. */
8606 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8607
8608 original_left = f->left_pos;
8609 original_top = f->top_pos;
8610
8611 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8612 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8613
8614 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8615
8616 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8617 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8618 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8619 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8620
8621 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8622 because the window manager may choose the position
8623 and we don't want to override it. */
8624
8625 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8626 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8627 && previously_visible)
8628 {
8629 Drawable rootw;
8630 int x, y;
8631 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8632
8633 BLOCK_INPUT;
8634
8635 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8636 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8637 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8638 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8639 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8640 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8641 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8642 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8643 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8644
8645 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8646 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8647 original_left, original_top);
8648
8649 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8650 }
8651
8652 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8653
8654 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8655 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8656 MapNotify at all.. */
8657 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8658 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8659 {
8660 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8661 x_sync (f);
8662
8663 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8664 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8665 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8666 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8667 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8668 probably a bug. */
8669 if (input_polling_used ())
8670 {
8671 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8672 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8673 handler reset it. */
8674 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8675 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8676 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8677 poll_for_input_1 ();
8678 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8679 }
8680
8681 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8682 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8683 }
8684
8685 /* 2000-09-28: In
8686
8687 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8688 (iconify-frame f)
8689 (raise-frame f))
8690
8691 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8692 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8693 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8694 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8695
8696 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8697 goto retry;
8698 }
8699 }
8700
8701 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8702
8703 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8704
8705 void
8706 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8707 struct frame *f;
8708 {
8709 Window window;
8710
8711 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8712 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8713
8714 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8715 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8716 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8717
8718 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8719 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8720 return;
8721 #endif
8722
8723 BLOCK_INPUT;
8724
8725 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8726 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8727 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8728 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8729 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8730 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8731
8732 #ifdef USE_GTK
8733 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8734 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8735 else
8736 #endif
8737 {
8738 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8739
8740 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8741 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8742 {
8743 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8744 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8745 }
8746 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8747
8748 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8749 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8750 {
8751 XEvent unmap;
8752
8753 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8754 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8755 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8756 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8757 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8758 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8759 False,
8760 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8761 &unmap))
8762 {
8763 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8764 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8765 }
8766 }
8767
8768 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8769 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8770 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8771 }
8772
8773 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8774 just by the event that we get from the server.
8775 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8776 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8777 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8778 f->visible = 0;
8779 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8780 f->async_visible = 0;
8781 f->async_iconified = 0;
8782
8783 x_sync (f);
8784
8785 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8786 }
8787
8788 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8789
8790 void
8791 x_iconify_frame (f)
8792 struct frame *f;
8793 {
8794 int result;
8795 Lisp_Object type;
8796
8797 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8798 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8799 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8800
8801 if (f->async_iconified)
8802 return;
8803
8804 BLOCK_INPUT;
8805
8806 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8807
8808 type = x_icon_type (f);
8809 if (!NILP (type))
8810 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8811
8812 #ifdef USE_GTK
8813 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8814 {
8815 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8816 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8817
8818 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8819 f->iconified = 1;
8820 f->visible = 1;
8821 f->async_iconified = 1;
8822 f->async_visible = 0;
8823 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8824 return;
8825 }
8826 #endif
8827
8828 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8829
8830 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8831 {
8832 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8833 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8834 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8835 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8836 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8837 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8838 so we have to record it here. */
8839 f->iconified = 1;
8840 f->visible = 1;
8841 f->async_iconified = 1;
8842 f->async_visible = 0;
8843 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8844 return;
8845 }
8846
8847 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8848 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8849 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8850 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8851
8852 if (!result)
8853 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8854
8855 f->async_iconified = 1;
8856 f->async_visible = 0;
8857
8858
8859 BLOCK_INPUT;
8860 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8861 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8862 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8863
8864 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8865 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8866 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8867 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8868
8869 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8870 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8871
8872 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8873 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8874 {
8875 XEvent message;
8876
8877 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8878 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8879 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8880 message.xclient.format = 32;
8881 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8882
8883 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8884 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8885 False,
8886 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8887 &message))
8888 {
8889 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8890 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8891 }
8892 }
8893
8894 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8895 IconicState. */
8896 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8897
8898 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8899 {
8900 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8901 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8902 }
8903
8904 f->async_iconified = 1;
8905 f->async_visible = 0;
8906
8907 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8908 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8909 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8910 }
8911
8912 \f
8913 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8914
8915 void
8916 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8917 struct frame *f;
8918 {
8919 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8920 Lisp_Object bar;
8921 struct scroll_bar *b;
8922
8923 BLOCK_INPUT;
8924
8925 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8926 commands to the X server. */
8927 if (dpyinfo->display)
8928 {
8929 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8930 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8931
8932 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8933 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8934 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8935 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8936 toolkit scroll bars. */
8937 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8938 {
8939 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8940 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8941 }
8942 #endif
8943
8944 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8945 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8946 free_frame_xic (f);
8947 #endif
8948
8949 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8950 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
8951 {
8952 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8953 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
8954 }
8955 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
8956 we are using a toolkit. */
8957 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8958 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8959
8960 free_frame_menubar (f);
8961 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8962
8963 #ifdef USE_GTK
8964 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
8965 frames. We must check and free both types. */
8966 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8967 {
8968 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8969 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
8970 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
8971 }
8972 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8973
8974 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8975 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8976 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8977
8978 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8979 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
8980 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
8981 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
8982 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
8983 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
8984
8985 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
8986 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
8987 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8988 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8989 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8990 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
8991 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
8992 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
8993 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
8994 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
8995 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8996 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
8997 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
8998 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
8999 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9000
9001 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9002 free_frame_faces (f);
9003
9004 x_free_gcs (f);
9005 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9006 }
9007
9008 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9009 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9010
9011 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9012 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9013
9014 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9015 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9016 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9017 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9018 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9019 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9020
9021 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9022 {
9023 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9024 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9025 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9026 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9027 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9028 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9029 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9030 }
9031
9032 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9033 }
9034
9035
9036 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9037
9038 void
9039 x_destroy_window (f)
9040 struct frame *f;
9041 {
9042 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9043
9044 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9045 commands to the X server. */
9046 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9047 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9048
9049 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9050 }
9051
9052 \f
9053 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9054
9055 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9056 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9057 that the window now has.
9058 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9059 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9060 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9061
9062 #ifndef USE_GTK
9063 void
9064 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9065 struct frame *f;
9066 long flags;
9067 int user_position;
9068 {
9069 XSizeHints size_hints;
9070
9071 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9072 Arg al[2];
9073 int ac = 0;
9074 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9075 #endif
9076
9077 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9078
9079 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9080 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9081
9082 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9083 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9084
9085 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9086 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9087 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9088 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9089 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9090 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9091 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9092 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9093 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9094 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9095
9096 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9097 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9098 size_hints.max_width
9099 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9100 size_hints.max_height
9101 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9102
9103 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9104
9105 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9106 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9107 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9108 {
9109 int base_width, base_height;
9110 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9111
9112 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9113 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9114
9115 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9116
9117 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9118 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9119 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9120 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9121 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9122
9123 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9124 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9125 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9126
9127 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9128 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9129 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9130 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9131 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9132 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9133 #else
9134 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9135 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9136 #endif
9137 }
9138
9139 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9140 if (flags)
9141 {
9142 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9143 goto no_read;
9144 }
9145 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9146
9147 {
9148 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9149 long supplied_return;
9150 int value;
9151
9152 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9153 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9154 &supplied_return);
9155 #else
9156 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9157 #endif
9158
9159 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9160 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9161 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9162 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9163 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9164 #endif
9165
9166 if (flags)
9167 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9168 else
9169 {
9170 if (value == 0)
9171 hints.flags = 0;
9172 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9173 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9174 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9175 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9176 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9177 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9178 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9179 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9180 }
9181 }
9182
9183 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9184 no_read:
9185 #endif
9186
9187 #ifdef PWinGravity
9188 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9189 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9190
9191 if (user_position)
9192 {
9193 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9194 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9195 }
9196 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9197
9198 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9199 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9200 #else
9201 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9202 #endif
9203 }
9204 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9205
9206 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9207
9208 void
9209 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9210 struct frame *f;
9211 int state;
9212 {
9213 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9214 Arg al[1];
9215
9216 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9217 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9218 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9219 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9220
9221 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9222 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9223
9224 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9225 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9226 }
9227
9228 void
9229 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9230 struct frame *f;
9231 int pixmap_id;
9232 {
9233 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9234
9235 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9236 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9237 #endif
9238
9239 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9240 {
9241 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9242 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9243 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9244 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9245 }
9246 else
9247 {
9248 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9249 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9250 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9251 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9252 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9253 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9254 best to explicitly give up. */
9255 #if 0
9256 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9257 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9258 #else
9259 return;
9260 #endif
9261 }
9262
9263 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9264
9265 {
9266 Arg al[1];
9267 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9268 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9269 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9270 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9271 }
9272
9273 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9274
9275 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9276 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9277
9278 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9279 }
9280
9281 void
9282 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9283 struct frame *f;
9284 int icon_x, icon_y;
9285 {
9286 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9287
9288 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9289 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9290 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9291
9292 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9293 }
9294
9295 \f
9296 /***********************************************************************
9297 Fonts
9298 ***********************************************************************/
9299
9300 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9301
9302 struct font_info *
9303 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9304 FRAME_PTR f;
9305 int font_idx;
9306 {
9307 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9308 }
9309
9310
9311 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9312
9313 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9314 to be listed.
9315
9316 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9317
9318 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9319 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9320 on how many fonts to match. */
9321
9322 Lisp_Object
9323 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9324 struct frame *f;
9325 Lisp_Object pattern;
9326 int size;
9327 int maxnames;
9328 {
9329 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9330 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9331 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9332 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9333 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9334 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9335 int count;
9336 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9337
9338 if (size < 0)
9339 {
9340 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9341 size = 0;
9342 }
9343
9344 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9345 if (NILP (patterns))
9346 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9347
9348 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9349 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9350 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9351
9352 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9353 {
9354 int num_fonts;
9355 char **names = NULL;
9356
9357 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9358 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9359 The cache is an alist of the form:
9360 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9361 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9362 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9363 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9364 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9365 if (!NILP (list))
9366 {
9367 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9368 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9369 goto label_cached;
9370 }
9371
9372 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9373
9374 BLOCK_INPUT;
9375 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9376
9377 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9378 {
9379 XFontStruct *font;
9380 unsigned long value;
9381
9382 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9383 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9384 {
9385 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9386 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9387 font = NULL;
9388 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9389 }
9390
9391 if (font
9392 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9393 {
9394 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9395 int len = strlen (name);
9396 char *tmp;
9397
9398 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9399 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9400 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9401 if (len == 0)
9402 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9403 else
9404 {
9405 num_fonts = 1;
9406 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9407 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9408 simple var. */
9409 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9410 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9411 XFree (name);
9412 }
9413 }
9414 else
9415 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9416
9417 if (font)
9418 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9419 }
9420
9421 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9422 {
9423 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9424 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9425 if (maxnames < 0)
9426 {
9427 int limit;
9428
9429 for (limit = 500;;)
9430 {
9431 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9432 if (num_fonts == limit)
9433 {
9434 BLOCK_INPUT;
9435 XFreeFontNames (names);
9436 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9437 limit *= 2;
9438 }
9439 else
9440 break;
9441 }
9442 }
9443 else
9444 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9445 &num_fonts);
9446
9447 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9448 {
9449 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9450 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9451 names = NULL;
9452 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9453 }
9454 }
9455
9456 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9457 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9458
9459 if (names)
9460 {
9461 int i;
9462
9463 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9464 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9465 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9466 {
9467 int width = 0;
9468 char *p = names[i];
9469 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9470
9471 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9472 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9473 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9474 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9475 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9476 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9477 while (*p)
9478 if (*p++ == '-')
9479 {
9480 dashes++;
9481 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9482 width = atoi (p);
9483 else if (dashes == 9)
9484 resx = atoi (p);
9485 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9486 average_width = atoi (p);
9487 }
9488
9489 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9490 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9491 {
9492 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9493 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9494 {
9495 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9496 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9497 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9498 >= 0))
9499 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9500 width of this font. */
9501 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9502 else
9503 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9504 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9505 }
9506 }
9507 }
9508
9509 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9510 {
9511 BLOCK_INPUT;
9512 XFreeFontNames (names);
9513 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9514 }
9515 }
9516
9517 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9518 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9519 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9520
9521 label_cached:
9522 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9523
9524 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9525 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9526 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9527 {
9528 int found_size;
9529
9530 tem = XCAR (list);
9531
9532 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9533 continue;
9534 if (!size)
9535 {
9536 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9537 continue;
9538 }
9539
9540 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9541 {
9542 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9543 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9544 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9545
9546 BLOCK_INPUT;
9547 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9548 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9549 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9550 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9551 {
9552 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9553 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9554 thisinfo = NULL;
9555 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9556 }
9557 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9558 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9559
9560 if (thisinfo)
9561 {
9562 XSETCDR (tem,
9563 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9564 ? make_number (0)
9565 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9566 BLOCK_INPUT;
9567 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9568 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9569 }
9570 else
9571 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9572 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9573 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9574 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9575 }
9576
9577 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9578 if (found_size == size)
9579 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9580 else if (found_size > 0)
9581 {
9582 if (NILP (second_best))
9583 second_best = tem;
9584 else if (found_size < size)
9585 {
9586 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9587 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9588 second_best = tem;
9589 }
9590 else
9591 {
9592 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9593 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9594 second_best = tem;
9595 }
9596 }
9597 }
9598 if (!NILP (newlist))
9599 break;
9600 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9601 {
9602 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9603 break;
9604 }
9605 }
9606
9607 return newlist;
9608 }
9609
9610
9611 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9612
9613 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9614 font table. */
9615
9616 static void
9617 x_check_font (f, font)
9618 struct frame *f;
9619 XFontStruct *font;
9620 {
9621 int i;
9622 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9623
9624 xassert (font != NULL);
9625
9626 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9627 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9628 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9629 break;
9630
9631 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9632 }
9633
9634 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9635
9636 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9637 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9638 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9639 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9640 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9641
9642 static INLINE void
9643 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9644 XFontStruct *font;
9645 int *w, *h;
9646 {
9647 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9648 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9649
9650 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9651 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9652 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9653 if (*w <= 0)
9654 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9655 }
9656
9657
9658 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9659 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9660 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9661 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9662 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9663
9664 static int
9665 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9666 struct frame *f;
9667 {
9668 int i;
9669 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9670 XFontStruct *font;
9671 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9672 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9673
9674 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9675 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9676
9677 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9678 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9679 {
9680 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9681 int w, h;
9682
9683 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9684 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9685 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9686
9687 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9688 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9689 }
9690
9691 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9692 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9693
9694 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9695 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9696 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9697 }
9698
9699
9700 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9701 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9702 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9703 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9704
9705 struct font_info *
9706 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9707 struct frame *f;
9708 register char *fontname;
9709 int size;
9710 {
9711 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9712 Lisp_Object font_names;
9713 int count;
9714
9715 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9716 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9717 we already have by comparing names. */
9718 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9719
9720 if (!NILP (font_names))
9721 {
9722 Lisp_Object tail;
9723 int i;
9724
9725 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9726 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9727 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9728 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9729 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9730 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9731 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9732 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9733 }
9734
9735 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9736 {
9737 char *full_name;
9738 XFontStruct *font;
9739 struct font_info *fontp;
9740 unsigned long value;
9741 int i;
9742
9743 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9744 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9745 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9746 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9747 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9748 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9749 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9750
9751 BLOCK_INPUT;
9752 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9753 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9754 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9755 {
9756 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9757 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9758 font = NULL;
9759 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9760 }
9761 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9762 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9763 if (!font)
9764 return NULL;
9765
9766 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9767 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9768 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9769 break;
9770
9771 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9772 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9773 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9774 {
9775 int sz;
9776 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9777 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9778 dpyinfo->font_table
9779 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9780 }
9781
9782 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9783 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9784 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9785
9786 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9787 BLOCK_INPUT;
9788 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9789 fontp->font = font;
9790 fontp->font_idx = i;
9791 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9792 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9793
9794 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
9795 {
9796 /* Fixed width font. */
9797 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
9798 }
9799 else
9800 {
9801 XChar2b char2b;
9802 XCharStruct *pcm;
9803
9804 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
9805 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
9806 if (pcm)
9807 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
9808 else
9809 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9810
9811 fontp->average_width
9812 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
9813 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
9814 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
9815 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
9816 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
9817 {
9818 if (pcm)
9819 {
9820 int width = pcm->width;
9821 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
9822 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
9823 width += pcm->width;
9824 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
9825 }
9826 else
9827 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9828 }
9829 }
9830
9831 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9832 full_name = 0;
9833 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9834 {
9835 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9836 char *p = name;
9837 int dashes = 0;
9838
9839 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9840 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9841 so don't use it.
9842 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9843 stored in them. */
9844 while (*p)
9845 {
9846 if (*p == '-')
9847 dashes++;
9848 p++;
9849 }
9850
9851 if (dashes >= 13)
9852 {
9853 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9854 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9855 }
9856
9857 XFree (name);
9858 }
9859
9860 if (full_name != 0)
9861 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9862 else
9863 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9864
9865 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9866 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9867
9868 if (NILP (font_names))
9869 {
9870 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9871 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9872 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9873 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9874 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9875 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9876 Qnil);
9877
9878 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9879 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9880 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9881 make_number (fontp->size)),
9882 Qnil)),
9883 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9884 if (full_name)
9885 {
9886 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9887 Qnil);
9888 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9889 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9890 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9891 make_number (fontp->size)),
9892 Qnil)),
9893 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9894 }
9895 }
9896
9897 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9898 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9899 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9900 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9901 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9902 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9903 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9904 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9905 fontp->encoding[1]
9906 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9907 /* 1-byte font */
9908 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9909 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9910 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9911 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9912 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9913 /* 2-byte font */
9914 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9915 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9916 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9917 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9918 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9919 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9920 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9921 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9922 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9923 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9924 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9925 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9926 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9927
9928 fontp->baseline_offset
9929 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9930 ? (long) value : 0);
9931 fontp->relative_compose
9932 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9933 ? (long) value : 0);
9934 fontp->default_ascent
9935 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9936 ? (long) value : 0);
9937
9938 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9939 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9940 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9941 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9942 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9943 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9944 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9945 return fontp;
9946 }
9947 }
9948
9949
9950 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9951 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9952
9953 struct font_info *
9954 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9955 struct frame *f;
9956 register char *fontname;
9957 {
9958 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9959 int i;
9960
9961 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9962 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9963 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9964 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9965 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9966 return NULL;
9967 }
9968
9969
9970 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9971 `encoder' of the structure. */
9972
9973 void
9974 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9975 struct font_info *fontp;
9976 {
9977 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9978
9979 elt = Qnil;
9980 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9981 {
9982 elt = XCAR (list);
9983 if (CONSP (elt)
9984 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9985 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9986 >= 0)
9987 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
9988 >= 0)))
9989 break;
9990 }
9991
9992 if (! NILP (list))
9993 {
9994 struct ccl_program *ccl
9995 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
9996
9997 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
9998 xfree (ccl);
9999 else
10000 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10001 }
10002 }
10003
10004
10005 \f
10006 /***********************************************************************
10007 Initialization
10008 ***********************************************************************/
10009
10010 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10011 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10012 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10013 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10014
10015 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10016 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10017 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10018
10019 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10020 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10021 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10022 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10023 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10024 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10025 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10026 };
10027 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10028
10029 static int x_initialized;
10030
10031 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10032 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10033 the screen number from the server number. */
10034 static int
10035 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10036 const char *name1, *name2;
10037 {
10038 int seen_colon = 0;
10039 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10040 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10041 int length_until_period = 0;
10042
10043 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10044 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10045 length_until_period++;
10046
10047 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10048 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10049 name1 += 4;
10050 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10051 name2 += 4;
10052 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10053 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10054 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10055 name1 += system_name_length;
10056 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10057 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10058 name2 += system_name_length;
10059 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10060 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10061 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10062 name1 += length_until_period;
10063 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10064 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10065 name2 += length_until_period;
10066
10067 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10068 {
10069 if (*name1 == ':')
10070 seen_colon++;
10071 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10072 return 1;
10073 }
10074 return (seen_colon
10075 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10076 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10077 }
10078 #endif
10079
10080 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10081 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10082 to 5. */
10083 static void
10084 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10085 unsigned long mask;
10086 int *bits;
10087 int *offset;
10088 {
10089 int nr = 0;
10090 int off = 0;
10091
10092 while (!(mask & 1))
10093 {
10094 off++;
10095 mask >>= 1;
10096 }
10097
10098 while (mask & 1)
10099 {
10100 nr++;
10101 mask >>= 1;
10102 }
10103
10104 *offset = off;
10105 *bits = nr;
10106 }
10107
10108 struct x_display_info *
10109 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10110 Lisp_Object display_name;
10111 char *xrm_option;
10112 char *resource_name;
10113 {
10114 int connection;
10115 Display *dpy;
10116 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10117 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10118
10119 BLOCK_INPUT;
10120
10121 if (!x_initialized)
10122 {
10123 x_initialize ();
10124 ++x_initialized;
10125 }
10126
10127 #ifdef USE_GTK
10128 {
10129 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10130 int argc;
10131 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10132 char **argv2 = argv;
10133 GdkAtom atom;
10134
10135 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10136 {
10137 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10138 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10139 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10140 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10141 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10142 }
10143 else
10144 {
10145 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10146 argv[argc] = 0;
10147
10148 argc = 0;
10149 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10150
10151 if (! NILP (display_name))
10152 {
10153 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10154 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10155 }
10156
10157 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10158 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10159
10160 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10161 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10162 #endif
10163
10164 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10165
10166 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10167 fixup_locale ();
10168 xg_initialize ();
10169
10170 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10171
10172 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10173 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10174
10175 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10176 {
10177 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10178 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10179 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10180
10181 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10182 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10183 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10184
10185 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10186 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10187
10188 UNGCPRO;
10189 }
10190
10191 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10192 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10193 }
10194 }
10195 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10196 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10197 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10198 errors with X11R5:
10199 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10200 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10201 So let's not use it until R6. */
10202 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10203 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10204 #endif
10205
10206 {
10207 int argc = 0;
10208 char *argv[3];
10209
10210 argv[0] = "";
10211 argc = 1;
10212 if (xrm_option)
10213 {
10214 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10215 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10216 }
10217 turn_on_atimers (0);
10218 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10219 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10220 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10221 &argc, argv);
10222 turn_on_atimers (1);
10223
10224 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10225 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10226 fixup_locale ();
10227 #endif
10228 }
10229
10230 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10231 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10232 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10233 #endif
10234 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10235 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10236 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10237
10238 /* Detect failure. */
10239 if (dpy == 0)
10240 {
10241 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10242 return 0;
10243 }
10244
10245 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10246
10247 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10248 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10249
10250 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10251 {
10252 struct x_display_info *share;
10253 Lisp_Object tail;
10254
10255 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10256 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10257 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10258 SDATA (display_name)))
10259 break;
10260 if (share)
10261 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10262 else
10263 {
10264 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10265 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10266 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10267 {
10268 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10269 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10270 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10271 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10272 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10273 BLOCK_INPUT;
10274 }
10275
10276 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10277 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10278 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10279 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10280 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10281 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10282 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10283 }
10284 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10285 }
10286 #endif
10287
10288 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10289 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10290 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10291
10292 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10293 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10294 x_display_name_list);
10295 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10296
10297 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10298
10299 #if 0
10300 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10301 #endif /* ! 0 */
10302
10303 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10304 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10305 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10306 + 2);
10307 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10308 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10309
10310 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10311 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10312
10313 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10314 #ifdef USE_GTK
10315 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10316 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10317 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10318
10319 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10320 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10321
10322 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10323 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10324 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10325 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10326 #else
10327 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10328 #endif
10329 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10330 all versions. */
10331 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10332
10333 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10334 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10335 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10336 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10337 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10338 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10339 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10340 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10341 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10342 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10343 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10344 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10345 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10346 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10347 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10348 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10349 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10350 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10351 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10352 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10353 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10354 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10355 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10356 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10357 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10358 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10359 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10360 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10361 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10362 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10363 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10364 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10365 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10366
10367 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10368 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10369 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10370
10371 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10372 {
10373 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10374 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10375 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10376 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10377 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10378 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10379 }
10380
10381 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10382 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10383 {
10384 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10385 {
10386 Lisp_Object value;
10387 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10388 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10389 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10390 Qnil, Qnil);
10391 if (STRINGP (value)
10392 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10393 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10394 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10395 }
10396 }
10397 else
10398 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10399 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10400
10401 {
10402 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10403 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10404 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10405 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10406 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10407 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10408 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10409 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10410 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10411 }
10412
10413 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10414 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10415 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10416 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10417 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10418 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10419 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10420 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10421 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10422 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10423 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10424 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10425 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10426 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10427 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10428 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10429 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10430 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10431 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10432 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10433 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10434 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10435 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10436 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10437 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10438 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10439 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10440 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10441 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10442 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10443 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10444 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10445 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10446 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10447 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10448 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10449 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10450 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10451 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10452 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10453 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10454 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10455 /* For properties of font. */
10456 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10457 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10458 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10459 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10460 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10461 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10462 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10463 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10464 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10465 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10466
10467 /* Ghostscript support. */
10468 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10469 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10470
10471 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10472 False);
10473
10474 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10475
10476 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10477 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10478
10479 {
10480 char null_bits[1];
10481
10482 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10483
10484 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10485 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10486 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10487 1);
10488 }
10489
10490 {
10491 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10492 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10493 dpyinfo->gray
10494 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10495 gray_bitmap_bits,
10496 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10497 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10498 }
10499
10500 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10501 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10502 #endif
10503
10504 #ifdef subprocesses
10505 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10506 if (connection != 0)
10507 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10508 #endif
10509
10510 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10511 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10512 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10513 /* stdin is a socket here */
10514 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10515 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10516 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10517 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10518 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10519 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10520
10521 #ifdef SIGIO
10522 if (interrupt_input)
10523 init_sigio (connection);
10524 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10525
10526 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10527 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10528 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10529 so that Xt does not crash. */
10530 {
10531 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10532 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10533 Font font;
10534 int count;
10535
10536 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10537 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10538 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10539 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10540 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10541 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10542 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10543 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10544 abort ();
10545 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10546 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10547 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10548 }
10549 #endif
10550 #endif
10551
10552 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10553 for debugging X code. */
10554 {
10555 Lisp_Object value;
10556 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10557 build_string ("synchronous"),
10558 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10559 Qnil, Qnil);
10560 if (STRINGP (value)
10561 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10562 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10563 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10564 }
10565
10566 {
10567 Lisp_Object value;
10568 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10569 build_string ("useXIM"),
10570 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10571 Qnil, Qnil);
10572 #ifdef USE_XIM
10573 if (STRINGP (value)
10574 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10575 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10576 use_xim = 0;
10577 #else
10578 if (STRINGP (value)
10579 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10580 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10581 use_xim = 1;
10582 #endif
10583 }
10584
10585 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10586 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10587 if (x_initialized == 1)
10588 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10589 #endif
10590
10591 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10592
10593 return dpyinfo;
10594 }
10595 \f
10596 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10597 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10598
10599 void
10600 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10601 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10602 {
10603 int i;
10604
10605 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10606
10607 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10608 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10609 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10610 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10611 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10612 else
10613 {
10614 Lisp_Object tail;
10615
10616 tail = x_display_name_list;
10617 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10618 {
10619 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10620 {
10621 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10622 break;
10623 }
10624 tail = XCDR (tail);
10625 }
10626 }
10627
10628 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10629 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10630
10631 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10632 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10633 else
10634 {
10635 struct x_display_info *tail;
10636
10637 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10638 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10639 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10640 }
10641
10642 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10643 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10644 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10645 #endif
10646 #endif
10647 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10648 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10649 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10650 #endif
10651 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10652 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10653 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10654 #endif
10655
10656 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10657 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10658 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10659 {
10660 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10661 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10662 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10663 }
10664
10665 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10666 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10667
10668 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10669 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10670 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10671 xfree (dpyinfo);
10672 }
10673
10674 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10675
10676 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10677 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10678 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10679 that slows us down. */
10680
10681 static void
10682 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10683 struct atimer *timer;
10684 {
10685 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10686 {
10687 BLOCK_INPUT;
10688 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10689 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10690 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10691 }
10692 }
10693
10694 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10695
10696 \f
10697 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10698
10699 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10700
10701 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10702 {
10703 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10704 x_produce_glyphs,
10705 x_write_glyphs,
10706 x_insert_glyphs,
10707 x_clear_end_of_line,
10708 x_scroll_run,
10709 x_after_update_window_line,
10710 x_update_window_begin,
10711 x_update_window_end,
10712 x_cursor_to,
10713 x_flush,
10714 #ifdef XFlush
10715 x_flush,
10716 #else
10717 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10718 #endif
10719 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10720 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10721 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10722 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10723 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10724 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10725 x_per_char_metric,
10726 x_encode_char,
10727 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10728 x_draw_glyph_string,
10729 x_define_frame_cursor,
10730 x_clear_frame_area,
10731 x_draw_window_cursor,
10732 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10733 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10734 };
10735
10736 void
10737 x_initialize ()
10738 {
10739 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10740
10741 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10742 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10743 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10744 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10745 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10746 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10747 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10748 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10749 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10750 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10751 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10752 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10753 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10754 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10755 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10756 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10757 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10758 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10759
10760 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10761 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10762 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10763 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10764 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10765 off the bottom */
10766 baud_rate = 19200;
10767
10768 x_noop_count = 0;
10769 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10770 any_help_event_p = 0;
10771 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10772
10773 #ifdef USE_GTK
10774 current_count = -1;
10775 #endif
10776
10777 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10778 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10779
10780 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10781 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10782
10783 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10784
10785 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10786 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10787 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10788 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10789 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10790 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10791 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10792
10793 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10794
10795 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10796 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10797 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10798 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10799 widgets don't behave normally. */
10800 {
10801 EMACS_TIME interval;
10802 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10803 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10804 }
10805 #endif
10806
10807 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10808 #ifndef USE_GTK
10809 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10810 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10811 #endif
10812 #endif
10813
10814 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10815 original error handler. */
10816 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10817 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10818
10819 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10820 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10821 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10822 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10823
10824 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10825 }
10826
10827
10828 void
10829 syms_of_xterm ()
10830 {
10831 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10832 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10833
10834 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10835 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10836
10837 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10838 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10839
10840 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10841 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10842
10843 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10844 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10845 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10846 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10847
10848 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10849 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10850
10851 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10852 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10853 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10854 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10855 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10856 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10857 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10858
10859 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10860 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10861 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10862 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10863 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10864 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10865 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10866 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10867 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10868
10869 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10870 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10871 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10872 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10873 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10874 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10875 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10876 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10877 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10878 #elif USE_GTK
10879 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10880 #else
10881 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10882 #endif
10883 #else
10884 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10885 #endif
10886
10887 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10888 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10889
10890 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10891 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10892 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10893 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10894 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10895 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10896 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10897 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10898 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10899
10900 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10901 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10902 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10903 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10904 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10905 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10906
10907 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10908 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10909 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10910 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10911 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10912 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10913
10914 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10915 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10916 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10917 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10918 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10919 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10920
10921 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10922 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10923 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10924 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10925 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10926 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10927
10928 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10929 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10930 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10931 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10932 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10933 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10934 }
10935
10936 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10937
10938 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10939 (do not change this comment) */